blob: 5d01835d7efb41f5032682ed2183e3a0c5286f0b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-options
626 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200627 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-options
629 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100630 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100631 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100632 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100633 - 51degrees-data-file
634 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200635 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200636 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200637 - wurfl-data-file
638 - wurfl-information-list
639 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100641 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100644 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200645 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200647 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100648 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100649 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100650 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200651 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200652 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200653 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200654 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655 - noepoll
656 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000657 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100659 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000661 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100662 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200663 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200664 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200665 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000666 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000667 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200668 - tune.buffers.limit
669 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200670 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200671 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100672 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100679 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100680 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100681 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100682 - tune.lua.session-timeout
683 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200684 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100685 - tune.maxaccept
686 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200687 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200688 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200689 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100690 - tune.rcvbuf.client
691 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100692 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200693 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100694 - tune.sndbuf.client
695 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100696 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100697 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200698 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100699 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200700 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200701 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100702 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200703 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100704 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200705 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
706 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
707 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100708 - tune.zlib.memlevel
709 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100710
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711 * Debugging
712 - debug
713 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200714 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715
716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007173.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718------------------------------------
719
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200720ca-base <dir>
721 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100722 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
723 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
724 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726chroot <jail dir>
727 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
728 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
729 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
730 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
731 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100732 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100733
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100734cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
735 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
736 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
737 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
738 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
739 set. These sets have the format
740
741 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
742
743 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100744 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
746 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100747 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
748 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100750 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100751 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
754 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
755 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
756 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100757
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100758 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
759 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
760 on the machine's word size.
761
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100762 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100763 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
764 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
765 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
766 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
767 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
768 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769
770 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100771 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
772
773 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
774 # first 4 CPUs
775
776 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
777 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
778 # word size.
779
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100780 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100781 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
783 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
784 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
785
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100786 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
787 # and so on.
788 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
789 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
790 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
791
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100792 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100793 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
794 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
795 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
796
797 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
798 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
799 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
800
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100801 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
802 # and a thread range.
803 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
804 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
805 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
806
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200807crt-base <dir>
808 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100809 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
810 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200811
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200812daemon
813 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
814 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100815 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
816 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200818deviceatlas-json-file <path>
819 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100820 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821
822deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
825
826deviceatlas-separator <char>
827 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
828 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
829
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100830deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200831 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
832 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
833 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100834
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900835external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100836 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
837 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100838 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
839 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
840 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
841 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
842 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900843
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200844gid <number>
845 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
846 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
847 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100848 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
849 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100851
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100852group <group name>
853 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
854 See also "gid" and "user".
855
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100856hard-stop-after <time>
857 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
858
859 Arguments :
860 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
861 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
862 SIGUSR1 signal.
863
864 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
865 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
866 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
867
868 Example:
869 global
870 hard-stop-after 30s
871
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200872h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
873 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
874 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
875 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
876 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500877 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200878 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
879 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
880 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
881 specified in a proxy.
882
883 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
884 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
885 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
886 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
887 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
888 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
889 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
890
891 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
892 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
893 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
894 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
895 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
896
897 Example:
898 global
899 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
900
901 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
902 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
903
904h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
905 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
906 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
907 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
908 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
909 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
910 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
911 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
912 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
913
914 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
915 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
916 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
917
918 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
919 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
920
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100921insecure-fork-wanted
922 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
923 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
924 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
925 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
926 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
927 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
928 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
929 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
930 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
931 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
932 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
933 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
934 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
935 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
936 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
937 disable it.
938
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100939insecure-setuid-wanted
940 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
941 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
942 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
943 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
944 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
945 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
946 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
947 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
948 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
949 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
950 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
951 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
952 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
953 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
954
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100955issuers-chain-path <dir>
956 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
957 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
958 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
959 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
960 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
961 "issuers-chain-path".
962 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
963 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
964 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
965 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
966 will share the chain in memory.
967
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200968log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
969 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100970 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100972 configured with "log global".
973
974 <address> can be one of:
975
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100976 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100977 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
978 port).
979
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100980 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
981 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
982 port).
983
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100984 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100985 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
986 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100987 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100989 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
990 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
991 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
992 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
993 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
994 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
995 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
996 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
997 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
998 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
999 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1000 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1001 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1002 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001003 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1004 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001005
1006 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1007 "fd@2", see above.
1008
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001009 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1010 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1011 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1012 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1013 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1014
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001015 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1016 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001017
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001018 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1019 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1020 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1021 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1022 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1023 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1024 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1025 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1026 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1027 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001028 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1029 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001030
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001031 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1032 one of the following :
1033
1034 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1035 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1036
1037 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1038 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1039
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001040 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1041 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1042 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1043 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1044 logger consumes.
1045
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001046 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1047 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1048 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1049 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1050
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001051 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1052 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1053 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1054 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1055 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1056
1057 <sample_size>
1058 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1059 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1060 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1061 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1062 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1063
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001064 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001066 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1067 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1068 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1069
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001070 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1071 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1072 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1073 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001074
1075 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001076 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1077 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1078 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1079 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1080 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1081 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001083 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001085log-send-hostname [<string>]
1086 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1087 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1088 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1089 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1090 the logs.
1091
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001092log-tag <string>
1093 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1094 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1095 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001096 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001097
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001098lua-load <file>
1099 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1100 used multiple times.
1101
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001102lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1103 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1104 variable.
1105 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1106 to "path".
1107
1108 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1109 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1110 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1111 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1112 will be checked earlier.
1113
1114 As an example by specifying the following path:
1115
1116 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1117 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1118
1119 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1120 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1121 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1122 paths if that does not exist either.
1123
1124 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1125 documentation.
1126
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001127master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001128 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1129 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1130 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001131 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001132 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1133 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001134 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1135 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1136 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1137 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1138 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001139
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001140 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001141
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001142mworker-max-reloads <number>
1143 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001144 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001145 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1146 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1147 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149nbproc <number>
1150 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1151 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1152 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001153 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1154 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001155 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1156 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001158nbthread <number>
1159 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001160 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1161 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1162 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1163 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1164 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001165 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1166 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1167 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1168 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1169 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1170 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1171 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001172
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001173pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001174 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1176 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1177
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001178presetenv <name> <value>
1179 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1180 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1181 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1182 and "unsetenv".
1183
1184resetenv [<name> ...]
1185 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1186 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1187 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1188 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1189 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1190 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1191 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1192 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1193
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001194stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001195 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1196 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1197 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1198 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1199 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1200 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001201 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001202 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1203 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1204 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1205 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001206
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001207server-state-base <directory>
1208 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001209 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1210 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001211
1212server-state-file <file>
1213 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1214 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1215 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1216 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1217 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1218 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1219 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1220 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001221 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1222 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001223
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001224setenv <name> <value>
1225 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1226 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1227 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1228 and "unsetenv".
1229
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001230set-dumpable
1231 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001232 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1233 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1234 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1235 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1236 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1237 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1238 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1239 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1240 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1241 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1242 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1243 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1244 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1245 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1246 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1247 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1248 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001249
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001250ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1252 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001253 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001254 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001255 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1256 information and recommendations see e.g.
1257 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1258 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1259 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1260 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001261
1262ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1264 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1265 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1266 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1267 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001268 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1269 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1270 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001271 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001272
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001273ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1275 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1276 keyword to see available options.
1277
1278 Example:
1279 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001280 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001281
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001282ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1284 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001285 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001286 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001287 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1288 information and recommendations see e.g.
1289 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1290 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1291 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1292 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1293 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001294
1295ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1297 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1298 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1299 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1300 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001301 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1302 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1303 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1304 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001305
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001306ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1308 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1309 keyword to see available options.
1310
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001311ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1313 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1314 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001315 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001316 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001317 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1318 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1319 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1320 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001321 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1322 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1323 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1324
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001325ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001326 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1327 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1328
1329 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1330 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1331 optimize the startup time.
1332
1333 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1334 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1335 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1336
1337 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001338 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001339
1340 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1341 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1342 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1343 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1344 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1345 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001346 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001347 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1348
1349 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1350
1351 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1352
1353 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1354 not provided in the PEM file.
1355
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001356 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1357 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1358
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001359 The default behavior is "all".
1360
1361 Example:
1362 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1363 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1364 ssl-load-extra-files none
1365
1366 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1367
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001368ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1369 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1370 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1371 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1372
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001373stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1374 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1375 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1376 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001377 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001378 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001379
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001380 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1381 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1382 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001383
1384stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1385 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1386 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001387 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001388
1389stats maxconn <connections>
1390 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1391 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393uid <number>
1394 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1395 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1396 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1397 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1398
1399ulimit-n <number>
1400 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1401 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1402 option.
1403
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001404unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1405 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1406
1407 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1408 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1409 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1410 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1411 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1412 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1413 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1414 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1415 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1416 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1417
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001418unsetenv [<name> ...]
1419 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1420 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1421 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1422 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1423 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1424 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1425 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427user <user name>
1428 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1429 See also "uid" and "group".
1430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001431node <name>
1432 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1433
1434 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1435 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1436 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1437 traffic.
1438
1439description <text>
1440 Add a text that describes the instance.
1441
1442 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1443 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1444 "<" and ">" characters.
1445
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100144651degrees-data-file <file path>
1447 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001448 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001449
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001450 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001451 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1452
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000145351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001454 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1455 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1456 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1457
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001458 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001459 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1460
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200146151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001462 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1463 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1464
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001465 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1466 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1467
146851degrees-cache-size <number>
1469 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1470 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1471 By default, this cache is disabled.
1472
1473 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001474 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1475
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001476wurfl-data-file <file path>
1477 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1478 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1479
1480 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1481 with USE_WURFL=1.
1482
1483wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1484 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1485 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1486 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1487
1488 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1489
1490 Valid WURFL properties are:
1491 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1492
1493 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1494 device.
1495
1496 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1497 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1498
1499 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1500 particular web request.
1501
1502 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1503 used Libwurfl API version.
1504
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001505 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1506 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1507
1508 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1509 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1510
1511 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1512
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001513 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1514 with USE_WURFL=1.
1515
1516wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1517 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1518 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1519
1520 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1521 with USE_WURFL=1.
1522
1523wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1524 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1525 thus before the chroot.
1526
1527 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1528 with USE_WURFL=1.
1529
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001530wurfl-cache-size <size>
1531 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1532 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001533 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001534 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001535
1536 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1537 with USE_WURFL=1.
1538
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001539strict-limits
1540 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1541 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1542 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1543 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1544 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1545 keyword.
1546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015473.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548-----------------------
1549
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001550busy-polling
1551 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1552 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1553 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1554 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1555 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1556 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1557 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1558 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1559 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1560 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1561 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1562 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1563 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1564 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1565 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1566 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1567 "poll" pollers.
1568
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001569 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1570 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1571 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1572
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001573max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1574 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1575 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1576 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1577 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1578 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1579 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1580 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1581 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1582
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001583maxconn <number>
1584 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1585 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1586 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001587 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1588 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1589 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1590 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001591 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1592 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1593 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1594 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1595 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1596 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001597
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001598maxconnrate <number>
1599 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1600 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1601 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1602 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1603 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1604 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1605 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1606 fairness.
1607
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001608maxcomprate <number>
1609 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001610 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001611 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1612 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1613 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001615 default value.
1616
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001617maxcompcpuusage <number>
1618 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1619 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1620 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1621 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1622 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1623 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1624 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1625 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1626
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001627maxpipes <number>
1628 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1629 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1630 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1631 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1632 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1633 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1634
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001635maxsessrate <number>
1636 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1637 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1638 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1639 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1640 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1641 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1642 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1643 fairness.
1644
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001645maxsslconn <number>
1646 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1647 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1648 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1649 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1650 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1651 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1652 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001653 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1654 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1655 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1656 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1657 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1658 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1659 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001660
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001661maxsslrate <number>
1662 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1663 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1664 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1665 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1666 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1667 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1668 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1669 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1670 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1671 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1672
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001673maxzlibmem <number>
1674 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1675 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1676 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001677 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1678 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1679 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1680
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001681noepoll
1682 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1683 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001684 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001685
1686nokqueue
1687 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1688 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1689 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1690
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001691noevports
1692 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1693 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1694 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1695 also "nopoll".
1696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001697nopoll
1698 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1699 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001701 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1702 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001703
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001704nosplice
1705 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001706 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001707 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001708 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001709 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1710 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1711 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1712 "option splice-response".
1713
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001714nogetaddrinfo
1715 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1716 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1717
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001718noreuseport
1719 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1720 command line argument "-dR".
1721
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001722profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1723 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1724 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1725 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1726 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001727 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001728 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1729 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1730 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1731 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1732
1733 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1734 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1735 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1736 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1737 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001738 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1739 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1740 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1741 CLI.
1742
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001743spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001744 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1745 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1746 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1747 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1748 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1749 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001751ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001752 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001753 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001754 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1755 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1756 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1757 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1758 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001759 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1760 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001761 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1762 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1763 openssl configuration file uses:
1764 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1765
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001766ssl-mode-async
1767 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001768 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001769 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1770 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1771 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001772 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001773 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001774
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001775tune.buffers.limit <number>
1776 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1777 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1778 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1779 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1780 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001781 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001782 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1783 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1784 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1785 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1786 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1787 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1788 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1789 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1790 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1791
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001792tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1793 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1794 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1795 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1796 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1797
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001798tune.bufsize <number>
1799 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1800 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1801 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1802 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1803 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1804 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1805 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001806 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1807 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1808 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001809 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001810 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1811 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1812 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001813
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001814tune.chksize <number>
1815 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1816 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1817 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1818 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1819 checks whenever possible.
1820
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001821tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1822 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1823 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1824 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1825 this value. The default value is 1.
1826
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001827tune.fail-alloc
1828 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1829 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1830 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1831 gracefully.
1832
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001833tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1834 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1835 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1836 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1837 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1838 change it.
1839
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001840tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1841 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001842 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1843 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001844 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1845 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1846 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1847 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1848 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1849
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001850tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1851 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1852 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1853 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1854 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1855 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1856 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1857 recommended not to change this value.
1858
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001859tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1860 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1861 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1862 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1863 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1864 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1865 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1866 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1867
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001868tune.http.cookielen <number>
1869 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1870 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1871 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1872 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1873 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1874 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1875 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1876 to change this value.
1877
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001878tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001879 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1880 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001881 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001883 configuration directives too.
1884 The default value is 1024.
1885
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001886tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1887 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1888 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1889 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1890 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1891 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1892 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001893 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1894 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1895 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001896
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001897tune.idletimer <timeout>
1898 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1899 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1900 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1901 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1902 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1903 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001904 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001905 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001906 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1907
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001908tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1909 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1910 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1911 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1912 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1913 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1914 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1915 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1916 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1917 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1918
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001919tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1920 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001921 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001922 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1923 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001925 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1926 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1927
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001928tune.lua.maxmem
1929 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1930 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1931 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1932 memory.
1933
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001934tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1935 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001936 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1937 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001938 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001939
1940tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1941 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1942 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1943 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1944 check servers.
1945
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001946tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1947 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1948 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1949 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001950 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001951
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001952tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001953 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1954 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1955 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1956 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1957 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1958 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1959 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1960 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1961 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1962 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001963
1964tune.maxpollevents <number>
1965 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1966 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1967 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1968 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1969 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1970
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001971tune.maxrewrite <number>
1972 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1973 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1974 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1975 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1976 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1977 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1978 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1979 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1980 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1981 bufsize.
1982
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001983tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1984 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1985 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1986 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1987 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1988 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1989 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1990 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1991 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1992 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001993 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1994 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001995 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1996 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1997 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1998 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1999 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2000 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2001 setting this parameter to 0.
2002
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002003tune.pipesize <number>
2004 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2005 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2006 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2007 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2008 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2009 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2010
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002011tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2012 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2013 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2014 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2015 default is 20.
2016
2017tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2018 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2019 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2020 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2021 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2022 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2023 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002024 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002025
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002026tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2027tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2028 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2029 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2030 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002031 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002032 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002033 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2034 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2035
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002036tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002037 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002038 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2039 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2040 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2041 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2042
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002043tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002044 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002045 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2046 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2047
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002048tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2049tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2050 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2051 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2052 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002053 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002054 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002055 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2056 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2057 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2058 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2059 notifying haproxy again.
2060
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002061tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002062 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2063 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2064 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002066 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002068 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2069 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2070 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002071 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2072 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002073
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002074tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002075 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002076 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2077 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2078 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2079 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2080 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2081
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002082tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2083 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002084 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002085 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2086 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2087 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2088 being used for too long.
2089
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002090tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2091 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2092 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2093 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2094 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2095 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2096 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2097 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2098 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2099 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2100 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002101 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002102 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002103
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002104tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2105 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2106 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2107 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2108 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2109 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2110 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2111 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002112 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2113 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002114
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002115tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2116 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2117 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2118 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2119 1000 entries.
2120
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002121tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2122 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2123 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2124 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2125
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002126tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002127tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002128tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2129tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2130tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002131 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2132 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2133 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2134 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2135 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2136 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2137 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2138 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002139
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002140 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2141 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2142 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2143 all available space is consumed.
2144 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2145 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2146 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002147
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002148tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2149 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002150 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002151 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002152 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002153 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2154
2155tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2156 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2157 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002158 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2159 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021613.3. Debugging
2162--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002163
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002164debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002165 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2166 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2167 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2168 system startup.
2169
2170quiet
2171 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2172 line argument "-q".
2173
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002174zero-warning
2175 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2176 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2177 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2178 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2179 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2180 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2181
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021833.4. Userlists
2184--------------
2185It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2186http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2187it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2188
2189userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002190 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002191 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2192
2193group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002194 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002195 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2196 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2197
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002198user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2199 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002200 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2201 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002202 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2203 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2204 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2205 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002206
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002207 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2208 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2209 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2210 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2211 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2212 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2213 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2214 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2215 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002216
2217 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218 userlist L1
2219 group G1 users tiger,scott
2220 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002221
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002222 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2223 user scott insecure-password elgato
2224 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002226 userlist L2
2227 group G1
2228 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002229
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002230 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2231 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2232 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002233
2234 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002235
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002236
22373.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002238----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002239It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2240several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2241instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2242values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2243automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2244In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2245using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2246tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2247reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2248Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2249that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2250each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002251
2252peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002253 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002254 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2255
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002256bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2257 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2258 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2259
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002260disabled
2261 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2262 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2263 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2264
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002265default-bind [param*]
2266 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2267
2268default-server [param*]
2269 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2270
2271 Arguments:
2272 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2273 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2274 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2275 details.
2276
2277
2278 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2279
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002280enable
2281 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2282
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002283log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2284 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2285 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2286 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2287 more details.
2288
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002289peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002290 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2291 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2292 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2293 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2294 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2295 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2296
2297 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2298 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2299
2300 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2301 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2302 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2303 across all peers.
2304
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002305 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2306 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2309 "server" keyword explanation below).
2310
2311server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002312 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002313 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2314 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2315 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2316 of this "peers" section).
2317 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2318
2319
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002320 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002321 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002322 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002323 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2324 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2325 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002326
2327 backend mybackend
2328 mode tcp
2329 balance roundrobin
2330 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2331 stick on src
2332
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002333 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2334 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002335
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002336 Example:
2337 peers mypeers
2338 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2339 default-server ssl verify none
2340 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2341 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002343
2344table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2345 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2346
2347 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2348 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002349 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002350 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2351 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2352 "stick-table" keyword).
2353
2354 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2355 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2356 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2357 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2358 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2359 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2360 of the stick-table name as follows:
2361
2362 peers mypeers
2363 peer A ...
2364 peer B ...
2365 table t1 ...
2366
2367 frontend fe1
2368 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2369
2370 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2371 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2372
2373 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2374 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2375 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2376 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2377 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2378 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2379 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2380
2381 peers mypeers
2382 peer A ...
2383 peer B ...
2384 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2385
2386 backend t1
2387 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2388
2389 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2390 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2391 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2392
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023933.6. Mailers
2394------------
2395It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2396If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2397in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2398
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002399mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002400 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2401 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2402
2403mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2404 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2405
2406 Example:
2407 mailers mymailers
2408 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2409 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2410
2411 backend mybackend
2412 mode tcp
2413 balance roundrobin
2414
2415 email-alert mailers mymailers
2416 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2417 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2418
2419 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2420 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2421
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002422timeout mail <time>
2423 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2424 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2425 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2426 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2427
2428 Example:
2429 mailers mymailers
2430 timeout mail 20s
2431 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002432
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024333.7. Programs
2434-------------
2435In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2436master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2437managed the same way as the workers.
2438
2439During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2440sequence as a worker:
2441
2442 - the master is re-executed
2443 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2444 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2445 instance of the program
2446
2447During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2448
2449program <name>
2450 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2451 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2452 the management guide).
2453
2454command <command> [arguments*]
2455 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2456 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2457 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2458 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2459
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002460user <user name>
2461 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2462 See also "group".
2463
2464group <group name>
2465 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2466 See also "user".
2467
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002468option start-on-reload
2469no option start-on-reload
2470 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2471 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2472 program section.
2473
2474
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024753.8. HTTP-errors
2476----------------
2477
2478It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2479imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2480several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2481
2482http-errors <name>
2483 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2484 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2485
2486errorfile <code> <file>
2487 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2488
2489 Arguments :
2490 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2491 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2492 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2493
2494 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2495 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2496 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2497 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2498 before any chroot is performed.
2499
2500 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2501
2502 Example:
2503 http-errors website-1
2504 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2505 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2506 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2507
2508 http-errors website-2
2509 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2510 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2511 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2512
2513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025144. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002515----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002517Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002518 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002519 - frontend <name>
2520 - backend <name>
2521 - listen <name>
2522
2523A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2524its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2525section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002527
2528A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2529connections.
2530
2531A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2532to forward incoming connections.
2533
2534A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2535parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2538'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2539case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2540
2541Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2542logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2543proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2544However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2545name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2546
2547Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2548and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002549bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2551modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2552arbitrary criteria.
2553
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002554In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2555a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002556the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002557
2558 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2559 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2560 between responses and new requests.
2561
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002562 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2563 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2564 client-facing connection remains open.
2565
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002566 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2567 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002568
2569The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2570frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2571following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002572weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002573
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002574 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002575
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002576 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2577 ----+-----+-----+----
2578 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2579 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002580 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2581 ----+-----+-----+----
2582 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002584
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025864.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2587--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002589The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2590limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2591they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2592limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002593marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002594option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002595and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2596with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2597specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002598
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002599
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002600 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2601------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2602acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002603backlog X X X -
2604balance X - X X
2605bind - X X -
2606bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002607capture cookie - X X -
2608capture request header - X X -
2609capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002610compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002611cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002612declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002613default-server X - X X
2614default_backend X X X -
2615description - X X X
2616disabled X X X X
2617dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002618email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002619email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002620email-alert mailers X X X X
2621email-alert myhostname X X X X
2622email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623enabled X X X X
2624errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002625errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626errorloc X X X X
2627errorloc302 X X X X
2628-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2629errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002630force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002631filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002632fullconn X - X X
2633grace X X X X
2634hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002635http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002636http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002637http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002638http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002639http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002640http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002641http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002642http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002644ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002645load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002646log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002647log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002648log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002649log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002650max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002651maxconn X X X -
2652mode X X X X
2653monitor fail - X X -
2654monitor-net X X X -
2655monitor-uri X X X -
2656option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2657option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2658option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2659option allbackups (*) X - X X
2660option checkcache (*) X - X X
2661option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2662option contstats (*) X X X -
2663option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2664option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002665-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2666option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002667option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2668option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002669option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002670option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002671option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002672option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002673option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002674option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2675option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2676option httpchk X - X X
2677option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002678option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002679option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002680option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002681option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002682option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002683option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2684option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2685option logasap (*) X X X -
2686option mysql-check X - X X
2687option nolinger (*) X X X X
2688option originalto X X X X
2689option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002690option pgsql-check X - X X
2691option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002692option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002693option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002694option smtpchk X - X X
2695option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2696option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2697option splice-request (*) X X X X
2698option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002699option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002700option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2701option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2702-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002703option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002704option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2705option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2706option tcpka X X X X
2707option tcplog X X X X
2708option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002709external-check command X - X X
2710external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002711persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2712rate-limit sessions X X X -
2713redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002714-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002715retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002716retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002717server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002718server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002719server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002720source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002721stats admin - X X X
2722stats auth X X X X
2723stats enable X X X X
2724stats hide-version X X X X
2725stats http-request - X X X
2726stats realm X X X X
2727stats refresh X X X X
2728stats scope X X X X
2729stats show-desc X X X X
2730stats show-legends X X X X
2731stats show-node X X X X
2732stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2734stick match - - X X
2735stick on - - X X
2736stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002737stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002738stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002739tcp-check connect - - X X
2740tcp-check expect - - X X
2741tcp-check send - - X X
2742tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002743tcp-request connection - X X -
2744tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002745tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002746tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002747tcp-response content - - X X
2748tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002749timeout check X - X X
2750timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002751timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002752timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002753timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2754timeout http-request X X X X
2755timeout queue X - X X
2756timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002757timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002758timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002759timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002760transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002761unique-id-format X X X -
2762unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002763use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002764use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002765use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002766------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2767 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2771---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002772
2773This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2774
2775
2776acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2777 Declare or complete an access list.
2778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2779 no | yes | yes | yes
2780 Example:
2781 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2782 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2783 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002785 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786
2787
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002788backlog <conns>
2789 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2791 yes | yes | yes | no
2792 Arguments :
2793 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2794 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002795 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002796
2797 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2798 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2799 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2800 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2801 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2802 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2803 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2804 backlog parameter.
2805
2806 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2807 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2808 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2809
2810 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2811
2812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002814balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2817 yes | no | yes | yes
2818 Arguments :
2819 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2820 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2821 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2822 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2823
2824 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2825 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2826 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2827 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002828 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002829 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002830 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2831 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2832 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2833 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2834 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2835 it, so that you don't worry.
2836
2837 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2838 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2839 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2840 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2841 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2842 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2843 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2844 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002846 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2847 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2848 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2849 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2850 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2851 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2852 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2853 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2854
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002855 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002856 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002857 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2858 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002859 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002860 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2861 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2862 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2863 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2864 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002865 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2866 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2867 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2868 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2869 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2870 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2873 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2874 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2875 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2876 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2877 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2878 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2879 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002880 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002882 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2883 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2884 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002886 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2887 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2888 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2889 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2890 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2891 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2892 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2893 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2894 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2895 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2896 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2897 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002898
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002899 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002900 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2901 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2902 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2903 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2904 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2905 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2906 URIs start with a leading "/".
2907
2908 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2909 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2910 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2911 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2912
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002914 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2915
2916 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002917 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2918 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002919 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2920 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2921 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2922 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002923 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002924 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2925 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002926
2927 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2928 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2929 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2930 server will receive the request.
2931
2932 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2933 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2934 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2935 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2936 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002937 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2938 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2939 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002940
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002941 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2942 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2943 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2944 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2945 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002947 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002948 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2949 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2950 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2951
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002952 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2953 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2954 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2955
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002956 random
2957 random(<draws>)
2958 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002959 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2960 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2961 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2962 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002963 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2964 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2965 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2966 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2967 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2968 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2969 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2970 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2971 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2972 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2973 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2974 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2975 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2976 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2977 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2978 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2979 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2980 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2981 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2982 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002983
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002984 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002985 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002986 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2987 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2988 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2989 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2990 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2991 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002992 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002993 used instead.
2994
2995 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2996 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2997 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2998 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2999
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003000 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3001 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3002 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3003
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003004 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003007 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3008 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003009
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003010 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3011 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3012 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003013
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003014 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003015 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003016 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3017 NTLM relies on.
3018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003019 Examples :
3020 balance roundrobin
3021 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003022 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003023 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3024 balance hdr(host)
3025 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003026
3027 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3028 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003030 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003031 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3032 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3033 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003034 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003035
3036 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3037 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3038 defaults to 16 kB.
3039
3040 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3041 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3042
3043 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3044 Round Robin.
3045
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003046 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003047 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3048 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3049 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3050
3051 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3052
3053 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003054 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003055 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3056 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3057 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003059 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003060
3061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003062bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3063bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003064 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3066 no | yes | yes | no
3067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003068 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3069 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3070 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3071 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003072 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003073 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3074 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3075 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3076 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3077 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3078 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3079 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003080 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3081 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3082 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3083 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3084 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3085 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3086 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003087 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3088 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3089 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003090 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3091 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3092 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3093 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003094 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3095 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3096 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003097
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003098 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3099 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003100 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3101 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3102 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003103 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3104 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3105 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3106 the range.
3107
3108 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3109 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3110 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3111 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3112 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3113 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3114 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003115 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003116 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003118 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003119 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003120 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3121 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3122 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3123 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3124 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3125 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3126
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003127 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3128 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3129 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3130 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003131
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3133 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3134 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3135 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3136 in a frontend.
3137
3138 Example :
3139 listen http_proxy
3140 bind :80,:443
3141 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003142 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003144 listen http_https_proxy
3145 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003146 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003147
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003148 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3149 bind ipv6@:80
3150 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3151 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3152
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003153 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003154 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003155
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003156 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3157 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3158 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3159 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3160 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3161
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003162 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003163 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164
3165
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003166bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003167 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3169 yes | yes | yes | yes
3170 Arguments :
3171 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3172 may be used to override a default value.
3173
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003174 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003175 option may be combined with other numbers.
3176
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003177 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003178 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3179 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3180 missing from all processes.
3181
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003182 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003183 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003184 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3185 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3186 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3187 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3188 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003189 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003190
3191 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3192 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3193 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3194 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3195 and 'even' instances.
3196
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003197 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3198 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3199 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3200 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003201
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003202 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3203 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3204
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003205 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3206 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3207 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3208
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003209 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3210 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3211
3212 Example :
3213 listen app_ip1
3214 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003215 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003216
3217 listen app_ip2
3218 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003219 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003220
3221 listen management
3222 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003223 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003224
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003225 listen management
3226 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3227 bind-process 1-4
3228
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003229 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003230
3231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003232capture cookie <name> len <length>
3233 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3235 no | yes | yes | no
3236 Arguments :
3237 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3238 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3239 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3240 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003241 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003242
3243 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3244 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3245 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3246 right if it exceeds <length>.
3247
3248 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3249 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3250 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3251 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3252
3253 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3254 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3255 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3256
3257 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3258 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3259 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003260 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3261 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3262 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263
3264 Example:
3265 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3266
3267 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003268 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
3270
3271capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003272 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3274 no | yes | yes | no
3275 Arguments :
3276 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003277 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3279 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3280 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3281
3282 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3283 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3284 it exceeds <length>.
3285
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003286 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003287 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3288 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003289 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3290 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3291 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3292 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003293 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003294 environments to find where the request came from.
3295
3296 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3297 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3298 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3299 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003301 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3302 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3303 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3304 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3305 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
3307 Example:
3308 capture request header Host len 15
3309 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003310 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003312 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313 about logging.
3314
3315
3316capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003317 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3319 no | yes | yes | no
3320 Arguments :
3321 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003322 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3324 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3325 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3326
3327 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3328 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3329 it exceeds <length>.
3330
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003331 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3333 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3334 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003335 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3336 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3337 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3338 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003340 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3341 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3342 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3343 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3344 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345
3346 Example:
3347 capture response header Content-length len 9
3348 capture response header Location len 15
3349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003350 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 about logging.
3352
3353
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003354compression algo <algorithm> ...
3355compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003356compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003357 Enable HTTP compression.
3358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3359 yes | yes | yes | yes
3360 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003361 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3362 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3363 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3364
3365 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003366 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3367 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3368 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003369
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003370 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003371 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003372
3373 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3374 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3375 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3376 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3377 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003378 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003379
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003380 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3381 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3382 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3383 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3384 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3385 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3386 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003387 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003388
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003389 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003390 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003391 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3392 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3393 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3394 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3395 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003396
3397 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3398 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3399 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3400 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3401 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003402 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3403 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3404 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3405 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3406 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003407 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3408 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003409
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003410 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003411 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3412 "Accept-Encoding" header
3413 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003414 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003415 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3416 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3417 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3418 "multipart"
3419 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3420 header
3421 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3422 and later
3423 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3424 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003425 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003426
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003427 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003428
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003429 Examples :
3430 compression algo gzip
3431 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003433
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003434cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003435 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3436 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003437 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3440 yes | no | yes | yes
3441 Arguments :
3442 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3443 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3444 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3445 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3446 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3447 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003448 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3450 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3451
3452 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3453 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3454 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3455 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3456 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3457 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003458 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3459 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003460 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003461 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3462 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
3464 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003465 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003466
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003467 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003468 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003469 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003471 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3472 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3473 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3474 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3475 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3476 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3477 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478
3479 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3480 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3481 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3482 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3483 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3484 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3485 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3486 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3487 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003488 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003489 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3490 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3491 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003493 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3494 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3495 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003496 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3497 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3498 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3499 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003500 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3501 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3502 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003503
3504 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3505 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3506 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3507 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3508 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3509 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3510 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3511 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3512 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3513
3514 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3515 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3516 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3517 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3518 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3519 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3520 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3521 persistence cookie in the cache.
3522 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3523
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003524 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3525 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3526 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3527 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3528 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003529 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003530 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3531 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3532 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3533 they logout.
3534
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003535 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3536 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3537 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3538 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3539
3540 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3541 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3542 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3543 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3544 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3545 this attribute.
3546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003547 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003548 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003549 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3550 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3551 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3552 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3553 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3554 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003555
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003556 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3557 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3558 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3559 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3560 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3561 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3562 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3563 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003564 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003565 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3566 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3567 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3568 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3569 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3570 the site.
3571
3572 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3573 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3574 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3575 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3576 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3577 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3578 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3579 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3580 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3581 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3582 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3583 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3584 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003585 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003586 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3587 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3588
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003589 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3590 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3591 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3592 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3593 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3594 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3595
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003596 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3597 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3598 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3599 repeated.
3600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003601 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3602 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3603 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3604 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606 Examples :
3607 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3608 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3609 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003610 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003612 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003613
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003614
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003615declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3616 Declares a capture slot.
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 no | yes | yes | no
3619 Arguments:
3620 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3621
3622 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3623 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3624 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3625 for use in the response.
3626
3627 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003628 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003629 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3630
3631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003632default-server [param*]
3633 Change default options for a server in a backend
3634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3635 yes | no | yes | yes
3636 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003637 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3638 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3639 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3640 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003641
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003642 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003643 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3644
3645 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003646
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003648default_backend <backend>
3649 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3651 yes | yes | yes | no
3652 Arguments :
3653 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3654
3655 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3656 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3657 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3658 will catch all undetermined requests.
3659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660 Example :
3661
3662 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3663 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3664 default_backend dynamic
3665
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003666 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003669description <string>
3670 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3672 no | yes | yes | yes
3673 Arguments : string
3674
3675 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3676 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3677 it describes.
3678 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3679
3680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003681disabled
3682 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3684 yes | yes | yes | yes
3685 Arguments : none
3686
3687 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3688 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3689 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3690 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3691 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3692 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3693 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3694
3695 See also : "enabled"
3696
3697
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003698dispatch <address>:<port>
3699 Set a default server address
3700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3701 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003702 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003703
3704 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3705 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3706 during start-up.
3707
3708 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3709 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3710 possible with normal servers.
3711
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003712 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003713 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3714 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3715 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3716 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3717
3718 See also : "server"
3719
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003720
3721dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3722 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3724 yes | no | yes | yes
3725 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3726
3727 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003728 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003729 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3730 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003731 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003732 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734enabled
3735 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3737 yes | yes | yes | yes
3738 Arguments : none
3739
3740 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3741 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3742
3743 See also : "disabled"
3744
3745
3746errorfile <code> <file>
3747 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | yes | yes | yes
3750 Arguments :
3751 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003752 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3753 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754
3755 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003756 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003757 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003758 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3759 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003760
3761 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3762 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3763 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3764
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003765 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003767 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3768 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3769 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3770 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3771
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003772 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3773 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003774 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003775 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3776 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3777 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3778
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3780 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3781 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003782 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003783 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3784
3785 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3786
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003787 Example :
3788 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003789 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003790 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3791 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3792
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003793
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003794errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3795 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3796 section.
3797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3798 yes | yes | yes | yes
3799 Arguments :
3800 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3801
3802 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3803 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3804 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3805
3806 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3807 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3808 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3809 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3810 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3811 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3812 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3813
3814 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3815 3.8 about http-errors.
3816
3817 Example :
3818 errorfiles generic
3819 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3820
3821
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003822errorloc <code> <url>
3823errorloc302 <code> <url>
3824 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827 Arguments :
3828 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003829 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3830 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003831
3832 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3833 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3834 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3835 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003836 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003837
3838 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3839 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3840 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3841
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003842 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3843
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003844 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3845 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3846 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3847 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003848 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3850 request.
3851
3852 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3853
3854
3855errorloc303 <code> <url>
3856 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3858 yes | yes | yes | yes
3859 Arguments :
3860 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003861 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3862 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003863
3864 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3865 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3866 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3867 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003868 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003869
3870 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3871 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3872 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3873
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003874 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3877 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3878 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3879 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003880 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003881
3882 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3883
3884
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003885email-alert from <emailaddr>
3886 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003887 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3889 yes | yes | yes | yes
3890
3891 Arguments :
3892
3893 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3894
3895 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3896 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3897
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003898 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003899 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3900 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003901
3902
3903email-alert level <level>
3904 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3905 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3907 yes | yes | yes | yes
3908
3909 Arguments :
3910
3911 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3912 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3913 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3914
3915 By default level is alert
3916
3917 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3918 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3919 for the proxy.
3920
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003921 Alerts are sent when :
3922
3923 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3924 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3925 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3926 is notice or lower
3927 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3928 and a health check status update occurs
3929
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003930 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3931 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003932 section 3.6 about mailers.
3933
3934
3935email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3936 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3938 yes | yes | yes | yes
3939
3940 Arguments :
3941
3942 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3943
3944 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3945 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3946
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003947 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3948 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003949
3950
3951email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3952 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3953 mailers.
3954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3955 yes | yes | yes | yes
3956
3957 Arguments :
3958
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003959 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003960
3961 By default the systems hostname is used.
3962
3963 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3964 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3965 for the proxy.
3966
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003967 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3968 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003969
3970
3971email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003972 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003973 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 yes | yes | yes | yes
3976
3977 Arguments :
3978
3979 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3980
3981 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3982 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3983
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003984 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003985 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3986
3987
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003988force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3989 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003991 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003992
3993 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3994 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3995 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3996 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3997 marked down for maintenance operations.
3998
3999 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4000 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4001 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4002 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4003 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4004 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4005 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4006 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4007 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4008
4009 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4010 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4011 is used.
4012
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004013 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004014 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004015
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004016
4017filter <name> [param*]
4018 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4020 no | yes | yes | yes
4021 Arguments :
4022 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4023 referenced in section 9.
4024
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004025 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004026 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004027 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4028 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004029
4030 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4031 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4032
4033 Example:
4034 listen
4035 bind *:80
4036
4037 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4038 filter compression
4039 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4040
4041 compression algo gzip
4042 compression offload
4043
4044 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4045
4046 See also : section 9.
4047
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004048
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004049fullconn <conns>
4050 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 yes | no | yes | yes
4053 Arguments :
4054 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4055 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4056
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004057 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004058 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004059 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004060 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4061 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4062 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4063 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4064 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004065 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004066
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004067 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4068 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004069 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4070 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4071 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004072
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004073 Example :
4074 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4075 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4076 # connections.
4077 backend dynamic
4078 fullconn 10000
4079 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4080 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4081
4082 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4083
4084
4085grace <time>
4086 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004088 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004089 Arguments :
4090 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4091 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4092 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4093
4094 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4095 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004096 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004097 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4098
4099 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4100 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4101 simplify it.
4102
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004104hash-balance-factor <factor>
4105 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4107 yes | no | no | yes
4108 Arguments :
4109 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4110 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004111 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004112
4113 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4114 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4115 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4116 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4117 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4118 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4119 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4120
4121 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4122 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4123 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4124 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4125 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4126
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004127 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4128 consistent hashing mechanism.
4129
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004130 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4131
4132
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004133hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004134 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4136 yes | no | yes | yes
4137 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004138 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4139 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004140
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004141 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4142 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4143 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4144 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4145 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4146 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4147 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4148 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4149 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4150 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004151
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004152 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4153 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4154 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4155 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4156 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4157 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4158 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4159 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4160 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4161 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4162 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4163 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4164 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004165 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4166 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004167
4168 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4169
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004170 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004171 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4172 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4173 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004174 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4175 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4176 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004177
4178 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4179 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004180 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4181 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4182 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4183 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4184
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004185 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4186 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4187 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4188 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4189 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4190 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4191 parameter.
4192
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004193 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4194 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4195 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4196 used on strings.
4197
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004198 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4199
4200 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4201 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4202 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4203 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4204 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4205 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4206 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4207 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4208 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4209 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4210 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4211 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004212
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004213 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4214 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4215 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004216
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004217 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004218
4219
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004220http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4221 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4222 ones).
4223
4224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4225 no | yes | yes | yes
4226
4227 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4228 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4229 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4230 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4231 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4232 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4233
4234 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4235 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4236 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4237
4238 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4239 below.
4240
4241 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4242 instance.
4243
4244 Example:
4245 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4246 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4247 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4248
4249http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4250
4251 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4252 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4253 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4254 example, or to pass some internal information.
4255 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4256 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4257 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4258
4259http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4260
4261 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4262 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4263
4264http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4265
4266 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4267
4268http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4269 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4270
4271 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4272
4273 Example:
4274 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4275
4276 # applied to:
4277 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4278
4279 # outputs:
4280 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4281
4282 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4283
4284http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4286
4287 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4288
4289 Example:
4290 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4291
4292 # applied to:
4293 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4294
4295 # outputs:
4296 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4297
4298http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4299
4300 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4301 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4302 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4303
4304http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4305 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4306
4307 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4308 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4309 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4310 fallback.
4311
4312 Example:
4313 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4314 http-response set-status 431
4315 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4316 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4317
4318http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4319
4320 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4321 inline.
4322
4323 Arguments:
4324 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4325 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4326 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4327 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4328 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4329 (request and response)
4330 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4331 processing
4332 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4333 processing
4334 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4335 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4336 and '_'.
4337
4338 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4339 followed by some converters.
4340
4341 Example:
4342 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4343
4344http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4345
4346 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4347 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4348 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4349 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4350 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004351 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004352 processing.
4353
4354 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4355 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4356 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4357 rules evaluation.
4358
4359http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4360
4361 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4362 details about <var-name>.
4363
4364 Example:
4365 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4366
4367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004368http-check disable-on-404
4369 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004371 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004372 Arguments : none
4373
4374 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4375 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4376 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4377 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4378 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4379 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4380 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4381 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004382 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4383 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4384 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4385
4386 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4387
4388
4389http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004390 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004392 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004393 Arguments :
4394 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4395 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004396 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004397 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4398 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4399 details on the supported keywords.
4400
4401 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4402 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4403 with the usual backslash ('\').
4404
4405 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4406 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4407 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4408 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4409 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4410
4411 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004412 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004413 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4414 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4415 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4416
4417 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004418 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004419 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4420 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4421 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4422 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4423
4424 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004425 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004426 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4427 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4428 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4429 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4430 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004431 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004432 trace).
4433
4434 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004435 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004436 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4437 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4438 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4439 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4440 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004441 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004442
4443 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4444 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4445 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4446 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4447 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4448 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4449 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4450 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4451
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004452 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4453 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4454 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4455
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004456 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4457 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4458
4459 Examples :
4460 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004461 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004462
4463 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004464 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004465
4466 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004467 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004468
4469 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004470 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004471
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004472 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004473
4474
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004475http-check send-state
4476 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | no | yes | yes
4479 Arguments : none
4480
4481 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4482 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4483 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4484 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4485 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4486
4487 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4488 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4489 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4490 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4491 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004492 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4493 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4494 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4495
4496 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4497 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4498 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4499
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004500 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4501 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4502 checked in multiple backends.
4503
4504 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4505 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4506
4507 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4508 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4509 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4510 one fails.
4511
4512 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4513 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4514 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4515
4516 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4517 server's queue.
4518
4519 Example of a header received by the application server :
4520 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4521 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4522
4523 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525
4526http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004527 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4528
4529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 no | yes | yes | yes
4531
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004532 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4533 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4534 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4535 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4536 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4539 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543 Example:
4544 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4545 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4546 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004548 http-request allow if nagios
4549 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4550 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4551 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004553 Example:
4554 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4555 acl add path /addacl
4556 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4561 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004563 Example:
4564 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4565 acl setmap path /setmap
4566 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004568 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004570 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4571 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4574 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004576http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004578 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4579 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4580 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4581 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4582 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4583 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4584 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4585 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4590 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4591 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4592 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4593 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4594 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4595 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4596 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004600 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4601 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004602
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004604http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4607 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4608 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4609 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4610 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004612 Example:
4613 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4614 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004615
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004616http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004617
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004618 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004620http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4621 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4624 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4625 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4626 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4627 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4628 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4629 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4630 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4631 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004633 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4634 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4635 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004636 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4637
4638 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4639 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4640 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4641 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004645 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4646 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4647 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4648 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4649 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4650 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004658 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4659 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4660 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4661 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4662 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4663 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004664
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004665http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4666 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4669 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4670 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004671 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4672 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4673 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4674 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4675 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004676 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004677
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004678http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4679 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4680 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4681 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4682
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004683http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4684
4685 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4686 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4687 pointed by <resolvers>.
4688 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4689 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4690 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4691 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4692 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4693 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4694 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4695 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4696 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4697 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4698 to 0.0.0.0.
4699
4700 Example:
4701 resolvers mydns
4702 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4703 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4704 timeout retry 1s
4705 hold valid 10s
4706 hold nx 3s
4707 hold other 3s
4708 hold obsolete 0s
4709 accepted_payload_size 8192
4710
4711 frontend fe
4712 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4713 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4714 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4715
4716 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4717 # which mean DNS resolution error
4718 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4719
4720 default_backend be
4721
4722 backend b_503
4723 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4724 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4725 # 503 error page to end users
4726
4727 backend be
4728 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4729 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4730 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4731 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4732 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4733
4734 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4735 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4736
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004737http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4738
4739 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4740 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4741 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4742 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004743 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4744 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004745
4746 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004750 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4751 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4752 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4753 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4754 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004756http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004758 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4759 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4760 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4761 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004763http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4764 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004765
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004766 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004767 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4768 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4769 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4770 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4771 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004772
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004773 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4774 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4775 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4776 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4777 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004778
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004779 Example:
4780 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4781
4782 # applied to:
4783 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4784
4785 # outputs:
4786 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4787
4788 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004789
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004790 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4791
4792 # applied to:
4793 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004794
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004795 # outputs:
4796 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004797
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004798http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4799 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4800
4801 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4802 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4803 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4804 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4805
4806 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4807 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4808 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4809
4810 Example:
4811 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4812 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4813
4814 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4815 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4816
4817 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4818 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4819 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4820 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4821
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004822http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4823 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4824
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004825 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4826 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4827 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4828 against.
4829
4830 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4831 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4832 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004833
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004834 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4835 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4836 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4837 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4838 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4839 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4840 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4841 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4842 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004843 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4844 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004845
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004846 Example:
4847 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4848 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004849
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004850 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4851 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004853http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4854 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004855
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004856 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4857 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4858 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4859 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004860
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004861 Example:
4862 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004863
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004864 # applied to:
4865 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004866
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004867 # outputs:
4868 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004869
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004870http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4871 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4872 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004873 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004874 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4875
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004876 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004877 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4878 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4879 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4880 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004881 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004882 are followed to create the response :
4883
4884 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4885 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4886 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4887 ignored.
4888
4889 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4890 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4891 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4892 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4893 ignored.
4894
4895 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4896 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4897 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4898 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4899 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4900
4901 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4902 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4903 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4904 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4905 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4906 if any, is ignored.
4907
4908 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4909 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4910 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4911 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4912 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4913 as a raw content.
4914
4915 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4916 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4917 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4918 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4919 considered as a raw string.
4920
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004921 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4922 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4923 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4924 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4925
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004926 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4927 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4928 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4929
4930 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4931
4932 Example:
4933 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4934 if { path /ping }
4935
4936 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4937 if { path /favicon.ico }
4938
4939 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4940 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4941 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004943http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4944http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004946 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4947 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4948 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004949
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004950http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4951 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004952
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004953 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4954 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4955 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4956 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004957
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004958http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004960 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4961 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4962 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4963 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4964 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004966 Arguments:
4967 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4968 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004970 Example:
4971 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4972 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004973
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004974 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4975 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004977http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004979 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4980 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4981 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004983 Arguments:
4984 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4985 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004987 Example:
4988 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4989 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004991 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4992 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4993 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004995http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004997 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4998 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4999 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5000 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5001 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005003 Example:
5004 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5005 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5006 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5007 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5008 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5009 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5010 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5011 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5012 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005016 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5017 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5018 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5019 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5020 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005022http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5023 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005025 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5026 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5027 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5028 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5029 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5030 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5031 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5032 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5033 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005035http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005037 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5038 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5039 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5040 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5041 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5042 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5043 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005045http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005047 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5048 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5049 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005051http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005052
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005053 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5054 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5055 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5056 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5057 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5058 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5059 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5060 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005062http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005064 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5065 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5066 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5067 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5068 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5069 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005071 Example :
5072 # prepend the host name before the path
5073 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005075http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005077 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5078 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5079 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5080 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5081 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005083http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005085 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5086 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5087 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5088 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5089 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5090 values have higher priority.
5091 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5092 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5093 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5094 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5095 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005097http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005099 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5100 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5101 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5102 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5103 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5104 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5105 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005107 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005108
5109 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005110 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5111 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005113http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5114 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5115 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5116 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
5117 privacy.
5118
5119 Arguments :
5120 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5121 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005122
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005123 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005124 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5125 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5126
5127 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5128 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5129
5130http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5131
5132 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5133 expression.
5134
5135 Arguments:
5136 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5137 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005138
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005139 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005140 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5141 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5142
5143 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5144 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5145 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5146
5147http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5148
5149 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5150 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5151 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5152 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5153 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5154 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5155 information from the request.
5156
5157 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5158
5159http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5160
5161 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5162 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5163 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5164 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5165 path and the query string.
5166 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5167
5168http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5169
5170 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5171 inline.
5172
5173 Arguments:
5174 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5175 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5176 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5177 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5178 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5179 (request and response)
5180 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5181 processing
5182 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5183 processing
5184 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5185 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5186 and '_'.
5187
5188 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5189 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005190
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005191 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005192 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005194http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5195 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005197 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5198 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5199 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5200 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5201 agent name must be used.
5202
5203 Arguments:
5204 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5205
5206 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5207 configuration.
5208
5209http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5210
5211 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5212 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5213 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5214 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5215 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5216 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5217 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5218 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5219 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5220 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5221 action.
5222 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5223 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5224 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5225 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5226 you fully understand how it works.
5227
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005228http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5229
5230 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5231 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5232 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5233 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5234 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005235 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005236 processing.
5237
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005238 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005239 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5240 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5241 rules evaluation.
5242
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005243http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5244 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005245
5246 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5247 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5248 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5249 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5250 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5251 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5252 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5253 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5254 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5255 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5256 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005257 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5258 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5259 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5260 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5261 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005262 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5263
5264http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5265http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5266http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5267
5268 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5269 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5270 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5271 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5272 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5273 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5274 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5275 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5276 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5277 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5278 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5279 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5280
5281 Arguments :
5282 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5283 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5284 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5285 select which table entry to update the counters.
5286
5287 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5288 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5289 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5290 that table until the session ends.
5291
5292 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5293 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5294 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5295 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5296 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5297 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5298 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5299 useful information.
5300
5301 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5302 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5303 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5304 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5305 checks that make use of it.
5306
5307http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5308
5309 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005310
5311 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005312 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005313
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005314http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5315
5316 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5317 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5318 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5319 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5320 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5321 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5322
5323 Arguments :
5324 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5325
5326 Example:
5327 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005329http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005331 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5332 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5333 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005334
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005335
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005336http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005337 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5338
5339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5340 no | yes | yes | yes
5341
5342 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5343 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5344 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5345 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5346 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5347 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005349 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5350 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005351
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005352 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005354 Example:
5355 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005357 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005359 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5360 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005362 Example:
5363 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005364
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005365 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005366
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005367 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5368 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005369
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005370 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5371 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005372
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005373http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005374
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005375 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5376 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5377 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5378 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5379 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5380 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5381 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5382 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005383
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005384http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005385
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005386 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5387 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5388 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5389 example, or to pass some internal information.
5390 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5391 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5392 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005393
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005394http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005395
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005396 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5397 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005398
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005399http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005400
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005401 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005402
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005403http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005405 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5406 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5407 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5408 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5409 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5410 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5411 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005412
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005413 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5414 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5415 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5416 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5417 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005418
5419 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5420 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5421 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5422 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005424http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005426 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5427 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5428 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5429 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5430 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5431 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005432
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005433http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005435 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005436
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005437http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005439 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5440 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5441 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5442 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5443 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5444 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005445
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005446http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005449 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005450 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5451 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005452 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5453 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5454 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5455 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5456 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005457 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005459http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005461 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5462 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5463 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5464 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5465 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5466 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005467
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005468http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5469 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005470
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005471 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5472 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005473
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005474 Example:
5475 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005477 # applied to:
5478 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005480 # outputs:
5481 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005482
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005483 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005484
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005485http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5486 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005487
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005488 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005489 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005491 Example:
5492 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005493
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005494 # applied to:
5495 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005496
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005497 # outputs:
5498 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005499
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005500http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5501 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5502 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005503 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005504 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5505
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005506 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005507 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5508 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5509 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5510 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005511 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005512 are followed to create the response :
5513
5514 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5515 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5516 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5517 ignored.
5518
5519 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5520 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5521 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5522 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5523 ignored.
5524
5525 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5526 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5527 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5528 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5529 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5530
5531 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5532 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5533 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5534 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5535 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5536 if any, is ignored.
5537
5538 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5539 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5540 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5541 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5542 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5543 as a raw content.
5544
5545 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5546 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5547 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5548 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5549 considered as a raw string.
5550
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005551 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5552 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5553 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5554 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5555
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005556 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5557 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5558 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5559
5560 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5561
5562 Example:
5563 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5564 if { status eq 404 }
5565
5566 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5567 string "This is the end !" \
5568 if { status eq 500 }
5569
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005570http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5571http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005572
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005573 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5574 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5575 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005576
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005577http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5578 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005579
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005580 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5581 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5582 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5583 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005584
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005585http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005586
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005587 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5588 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5589 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5590 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5591 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005592
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005593 Arguments:
5594 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005595
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005596 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5597 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005599http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005600
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005601 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5602 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5603 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005604
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005605http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5606
5607 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5608 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5609 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5610 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5611 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5612
5613http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5614
5615 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5616 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5617 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5618 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5619 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5620 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5621 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5622 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5623 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5624
5625http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5626
5627 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5628 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5629 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5630 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5631 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5632 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5633 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5634
5635http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5636
5637 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5638 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5639 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5640 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5641 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5642 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5643 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5644 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5645
5646http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5647 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5648
5649 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5650 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5651 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5652 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005653
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005654 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005655 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5656 http-response set-status 431
5657 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5658 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005659
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005660http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005661
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005662 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5663 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5664 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5665 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5666 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5667 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5668 based on some information from the request.
5669
5670 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5671
5672http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5673
5674 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5675 inline.
5676
5677 Arguments:
5678 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5679 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5680 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5681 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5682 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5683 (request and response)
5684 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5685 processing
5686 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5687 processing
5688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5689 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5690 and '_'.
5691
5692 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5693 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005694
5695 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005696 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005698http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005700 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5701 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5702 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5703 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5704 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5705 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5706 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5707 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5708 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5709 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5710 action.
5711 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5712 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5713 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5714 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5715 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005716
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005717http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5718
5719 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5720 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5721 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5722 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5723 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005724 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005725 processing.
5726
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005727 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005728 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5729 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5730 rules evaluation.
5731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005732http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5733http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5734http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005735
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005736 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5737 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5738 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5739 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5740 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5741 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5742
5743http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5744
5745 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5746 about <var-name>.
5747
5748 Example:
5749 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5750
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005751
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005752http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5753 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5754
5755 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | no | yes | yes
5757
5758 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005759 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5760 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5761 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005762
5763 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5764
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005765 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5766 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5767 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5768 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5769 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5770 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5771 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5772 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5773 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5774 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005775
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005776 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5777 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5778 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5779 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5780 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5781 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5782 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5783 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005784
5785 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5786 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5787 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5788 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5789 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5790 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5791 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5792 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005793 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005794 downsides of rare connection failures.
5795
5796 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5797 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5798 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5799 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5800 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5801 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005802 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005803 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5804 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5805 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5806 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5807 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5808
5809 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005810 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5811 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5812 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005813
5814 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005815 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005816
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005817 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5818 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005819
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005820 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005821
5822 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5823 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5824 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5825
5826 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5827
5828
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005829http-send-name-header [<header>]
5830 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005831 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005833 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005834 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5835
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005836 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5837 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5838 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5839 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5840 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5841 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5842 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5843 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5844 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5845 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5846 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5847 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5848 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5849 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5850 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5851 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005852
5853 See also : "server"
5854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005855id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005856 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 no | yes | yes | yes
5859 Arguments : none
5860
5861 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5862 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5863 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005864
5865
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005866ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5867 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005869 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005870
5871 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5872 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5873 and running).
5874
5875 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5876 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5877 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005878 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005879 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5880
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005881 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5882 "unless" condition is met.
5883
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005884 Example:
5885 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5886 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5887 ignore-persist if url_static
5888
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005889 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5890
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005891load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5892 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | no | yes | yes
5895
5896 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5897 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5898 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005899 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005900 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5901 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5902 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5903 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5904
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005905 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005906 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005907 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005908
5909 Arguments:
5910 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5911 named "server-state-file".
5912
5913 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5914 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5915 name is used as a file name.
5916
5917 none don't load any stat for this backend
5918
5919 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005920 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5921 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5922 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005923 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005924 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005925
5926 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5927 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5928
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005929 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005930
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005931 global
5932 stats socket /tmp/socket
5933 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005934
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005935 defaults
5936 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005937
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005938 backend bk
5939 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5940 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005941
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005942
5943 Then one can run :
5944
5945 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5946
5947 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5948
5949 1
5950 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5951 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5952 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5953
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005954 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005955
5956 global
5957 stats socket /tmp/socket
5958 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5959
5960 defaults
5961 load-server-state-from-file local
5962
5963 backend bk
5964 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5965 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5966
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005967
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005968 Then one can run :
5969
5970 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5971
5972 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5973
5974 1
5975 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5976 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5977 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5978
5979 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5980 "show servers state"
5981
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005982
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005983log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005984log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5985 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005986no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005987 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5989 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005990
5991 Prefix :
5992 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5993 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5994 prefix does not allow arguments.
5995
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005996 Arguments :
5997 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5998 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5999 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6000 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6001 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6002 parameter.
6003
6004 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6005 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6006
6007 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6008 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6009 standard syslog port).
6010
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006011 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6012 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6013 standard syslog port).
6014
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006015 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6016 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6017 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006018 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006019
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006020 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6021 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6022 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6023 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6024 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6025 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6026 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6027 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6028 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6029 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6030 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6031 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6032 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6033 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6034 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6035 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006036 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6037 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006038
6039 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6040 and "fd@2", see above.
6041
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006042 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6043 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6044 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6045 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6046 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6047 having the logs instantly available.
6048
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006049 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6050 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006051
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006052 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6053 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6054 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6055 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6056 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6057 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6058 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6059 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6060 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6061 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006062 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006063
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006064 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6065 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6066 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6067 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6068 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6069
6070 <sample_size>
6071 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6072 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6073 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6074 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6075 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6076
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006077 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6078 one of the following :
6079
6080 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6081 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6082
6083 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6084 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6085
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006086 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6087 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6088 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6089 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6090 systemd logger consumes.
6091
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006092 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6093 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6094 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6095 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6096
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006097 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6098
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006099 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6100 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6101 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6102
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006103 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6104 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6105 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6106 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006107
6108 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6109 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6110 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006111 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6112 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6113 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6114 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6115 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006116
6117 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6118
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006119 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6120 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6121 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006122
6123 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6124 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6125 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6126 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6127
6128 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6129 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006130
6131 Example :
6132 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006133 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6134 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6135 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006136 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6137 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006138 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006139
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006140
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006141log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006142 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6143 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6144 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006145
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006146 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6147 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6148 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6149 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6150 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006151
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006152 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6153 "option httplog" directives.
6154
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006155log-format-sd <string>
6156 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6158 yes | yes | yes | no
6159
6160 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6161 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6162 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6163 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6164 which covers the log format string in depth.
6165
6166 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6167 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6168
6169 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6170 log format to "rfc5424".
6171
6172 Example :
6173 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6174
6175
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006176log-tag <string>
6177 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6179 yes | yes | yes | yes
6180
6181 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6182 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6183 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6184 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6185 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6186 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6187 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6188 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6189 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006190
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006191max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6192 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | no | yes | yes
6195
6196 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6197 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6198 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6199 servers.
6200
6201 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6202 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6203 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6204 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6205 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006206 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006207 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6208 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6209 picking a different server.
6210
6211 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6212 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6213 even if they have to be queued.
6214
6215 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6216 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6217
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006218max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6219 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6220 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6221 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006222
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006223maxconn <conns>
6224 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6226 yes | yes | yes | no
6227 Arguments :
6228 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6229 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6230 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6231 closes.
6232
6233 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6234 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6235 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6236 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006237 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6238 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6239 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6240 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006241
6242 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6243 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6244 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6245
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006246 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6247 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006249 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6250
6251
6252mode { tcp|http|health }
6253 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6255 yes | yes | yes | yes
6256 Arguments :
6257 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6258 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6259 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6260 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6261
6262 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6263 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6264 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6265 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6266 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6267
6268 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006269 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6270 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6271 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6272 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6273 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6274 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6275 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006276
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006277 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6278 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6279 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006280
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006281 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006282 defaults http_instances
6283 mode http
6284
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006285 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006286
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006287
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006288monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006289 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6291 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006292 Arguments :
6293 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6294 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006295 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006296 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6297 backend and its backup.
6298
6299 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6300 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6301 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6302 servers in a list of backends.
6303
6304 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6305 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6306 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6307 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6308 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6309 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6310 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006311 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6312 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006313
6314 Example:
6315 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006316 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006317 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6318 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6319 monitor-uri /site_alive
6320 monitor fail if site_dead
6321
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006322 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006323
6324
6325monitor-net <source>
6326 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6328 yes | yes | yes | no
6329 Arguments :
6330 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6331 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6332 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6333 followed by a mask.
6334
6335 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6336 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006337 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006338 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6339
6340 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6341 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6342 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6343 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006344 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6345 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6346 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006347
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006348 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6349 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6350 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6351 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6352 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6353 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006354
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006355 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6356 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006357
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006358 Example :
6359 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6360 frontend www
6361 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6362
6363 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6364
6365
6366monitor-uri <uri>
6367 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6369 yes | yes | yes | no
6370 Arguments :
6371 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6372 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6373
6374 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6375 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6376 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6377 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6378 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6379 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6380 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6381 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6382
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006383 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006384 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6385 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6386 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6387 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6388 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6389 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006390
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006391 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6392 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6393 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6394 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6395
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006396 Example :
6397 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6398 frontend www
6399 mode http
6400 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6401
6402 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006404
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006405option abortonclose
6406no option abortonclose
6407 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6409 yes | no | yes | yes
6410 Arguments : none
6411
6412 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6413 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6414 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6415 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006416 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006417 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6418 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6419 encountered while delivering the response.
6420
6421 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6422 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6423 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6424 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6425 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6426 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006427 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006428 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006429 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006430 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6431 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6432 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6433
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006434 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6435 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006436 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6437 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6438 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6439 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6440 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6441 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006442 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006443
6444 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6445 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6446
6447 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6448
6449
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006450option accept-invalid-http-request
6451no option accept-invalid-http-request
6452 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | yes | yes | no
6455 Arguments : none
6456
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006457 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006458 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006459 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006460 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6461 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6462 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6463 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6464 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006465 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6466 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6467 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6468 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006469 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006470 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006471 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6472 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6473 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006474
6475 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6476 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6477 been confirmed.
6478
6479 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6480 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006481 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6482 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006483 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6484
6485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6487
6488 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6489 stats socket.
6490
6491
6492option accept-invalid-http-response
6493no option accept-invalid-http-response
6494 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6496 yes | no | yes | yes
6497 Arguments : none
6498
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006499 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006500 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006501 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006502 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6503 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6504 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6505 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6506 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006507 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6508 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6509 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006510
6511 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6512 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6513 been confirmed.
6514
6515 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6516 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6517 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6518 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6519
6520 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6521 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6522
6523 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6524 stats socket.
6525
6526
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006527option allbackups
6528no option allbackups
6529 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6531 yes | no | yes | yes
6532 Arguments : none
6533
6534 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6535 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6536 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6537 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6538 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6539 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6540 order between the backup servers anymore.
6541
6542 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6543 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6544
6545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6547
6548
6549option checkcache
6550no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006551 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6553 yes | no | yes | yes
6554 Arguments : none
6555
6556 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6557 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006558 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006559 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6560 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006561 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006562
6563 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006564 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006565 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006566 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6567 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006568 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006569 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006570 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6571 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006572 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006573 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6574 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006575 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006576 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6577 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6578 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6579 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6580 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6581 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6582 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6583 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6584 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6585
6586 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006587 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6588 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6589 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6590 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006591
6592 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6593 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006594 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006595 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006596
6597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6599
6600
6601option clitcpka
6602no option clitcpka
6603 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6605 yes | yes | yes | no
6606 Arguments : none
6607
6608 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6609 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006610 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006611 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6612
6613 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6614 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6615 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6616 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6617
6618 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6619 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6620 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6621 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6622 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6623
6624 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6625
6626 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6627 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6628 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6629
6630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6632
6633 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6634
6635
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006636option contstats
6637 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6639 yes | yes | yes | no
6640 Arguments : none
6641
6642 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6643 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6644 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6645 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006646 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6647 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6648 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6649 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6650 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006651
6652
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006653option dontlog-normal
6654no option dontlog-normal
6655 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 yes | yes | yes | no
6658 Arguments : none
6659
6660 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6661 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6662 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6663 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6664 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6665 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6666 logged.
6667
6668 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6669 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6670 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006672 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006673 logging.
6674
6675
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006676option dontlognull
6677no option dontlognull
6678 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6680 yes | yes | yes | no
6681 Arguments : none
6682
6683 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6684 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6685 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6686 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6687 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6688 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006689 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6690 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6691 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006692
6693 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006694 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006695 would not be logged.
6696
6697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6699
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006700 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6701 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006702
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006703
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006704option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006705 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 yes | yes | yes | yes
6708 Arguments :
6709 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6710 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006711 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006712 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006713
6714 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6715 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6716 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6717 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6718 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6719 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6720 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006721 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6722 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6723 possible that the client has already brought one.
6724
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006725 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006726 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006727 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006728 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006729 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006730 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006731
6732 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6733 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6734 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6735 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6736 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6737 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6738 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6739
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006740 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6741 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6742 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6743 are under the control of the end-user.
6744
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006745 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006746 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6747 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006748 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6749 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6750 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006751
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006752 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006753 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6754 frontend www
6755 mode http
6756 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6757
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006758 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6759 backend www
6760 mode http
6761 option forwardfor header X-Client
6762
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006763 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006764 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006765
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006766
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006767option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6768no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6769 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6771 yes | yes | yes | no
6772 Arguments : none
6773
6774 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6775 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6776 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6777 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6778 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6779 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6780 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6781
6782 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6783 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6784 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6785 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6786 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6787 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6788 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6789 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6790 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6791 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6792
6793 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6794
6795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6797
6798 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6799 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6800
6801
6802option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6803no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6804 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6806 yes | no | yes | yes
6807 Arguments : none
6808
6809 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6810 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6811 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6812 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6813 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6814 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6815 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6816
6817 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6818 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6819 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6820 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6821 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6822 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6823 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6824 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6825 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6826 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6827
6828 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6829
6830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6832
6833 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6834 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6835
6836
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006837option http-buffer-request
6838no option http-buffer-request
6839 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6841 yes | yes | yes | yes
6842 Arguments : none
6843
6844 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6845 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6846 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6847 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6848 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6849 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006850 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6851 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6852 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6853 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006854
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006855 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006856
6857
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006858option http-ignore-probes
6859no option http-ignore-probes
6860 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 yes | yes | yes | no
6863 Arguments : none
6864
6865 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6866 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6867 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6868 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6869 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6870 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6871 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6872 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6873 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006874 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6875 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006876 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6877
6878 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6879 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6880 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6881 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6882 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6883 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6884 are often the only way to detect them.
6885
6886 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6887 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6888
6889 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6890
6891
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006892option http-keep-alive
6893no option http-keep-alive
6894 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6896 yes | yes | yes | yes
6897 Arguments : none
6898
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006899 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6900 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006901 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6902 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006903 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6904 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6905 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006906
6907 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6908 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006909 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6910 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6911 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6912 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6913 situations where this option may be useful :
6914
6915 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006916 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006917
6918 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6919 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6920
6921 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6922 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6923 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6924 request.
6925
6926 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6927 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006928 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6929 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6930 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006931
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006932 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6933 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6934 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6935 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6936 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6937 not set.
6938
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006939 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6940 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6941 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006942
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006943 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006944 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006945 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006946
6947
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006948option http-no-delay
6949no option http-no-delay
6950 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6952 yes | yes | yes | yes
6953 Arguments : none
6954
6955 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6956 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6957 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6958 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6959 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6960 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6961 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6962 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6963 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6964 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6965 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6966 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6967 affected.
6968
6969 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6970 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6971 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6972 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6973 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6974 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6975 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6976 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6977 latency environments.
6978
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006979 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6980
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006981
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006982option http-pretend-keepalive
6983no option http-pretend-keepalive
6984 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006986 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006987 Arguments : none
6988
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006989 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006990 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6991 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6992 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6993 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6994 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6995 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6996 consider the response complete.
6997
6998 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6999 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7000 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7001 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007002 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007003 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7004
7005 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7006 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7007 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7008 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7009 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7010 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7011 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7012
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007013 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7014 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7015 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7016 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7017 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7018 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007019
7020 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7021 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7022
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007023 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007024 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007025
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007026
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007027option http-server-close
7028no option http-server-close
7029 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7031 yes | yes | yes | yes
7032 Arguments : none
7033
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007034 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7035 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7036 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7037 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007038 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7039 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7040 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7041 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7042 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7043 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7044 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7045 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7046 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7047 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7048 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007049
7050 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7051 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7052 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7053 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007054 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7055 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007056
7057 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7058 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007059 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7060 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7061 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007062
7063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7065
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007066 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7067 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007068
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007069option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007070no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007071 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7073 yes | yes | yes | no
7074 Arguments : none
7075
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007076 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007077 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7078 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7079 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7080 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7081 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7082 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7083
7084 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7085 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007086 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7087 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7088 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007089
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007090 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7091 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7092 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7093 front of an existing proxy.
7094
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007095 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7096
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007097 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007098
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007099option httpchk
7100option httpchk <uri>
7101option httpchk <method> <uri>
7102option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7103 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7105 yes | no | yes | yes
7106 Arguments :
7107 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7108 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7109 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7110 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7111 ones.
7112
7113 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7114 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7115 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7116
7117 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7118 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7119 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
7120 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
7121 after "\r\n" following the version string.
7122
7123 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7124 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7125 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7126 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7127 the lack of any response.
7128
7129 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7130
7131 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7132 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7133 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7134
7135 Examples :
7136 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7137 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7138 backend https_relay
7139 mode tcp
7140 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
7141 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7142
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007143 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7144 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7145 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007146
7147
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007148option httpclose
7149no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007150 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7152 yes | yes | yes | yes
7153 Arguments : none
7154
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007155 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7156 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7157 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7158 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007159 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007160
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007161 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7162 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007163 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007164 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7165 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007166
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007167 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7168 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7169 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007170
7171 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7172 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007173 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7174 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7175 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007176
7177 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7178 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7179
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007180 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007181
7182
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007183option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007184 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007186 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007187 Arguments :
7188 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7189 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7190 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007191 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007192 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007193
7194 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7195 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7196 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7197 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7198 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7199 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7200 ports.
7201
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007202 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7203 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007204
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007205 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007207 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007208
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007209
7210option http_proxy
7211no option http_proxy
7212 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7214 yes | yes | yes | yes
7215 Arguments : none
7216
7217 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7218 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7219 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7220 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7221 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7222
7223 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7224 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007225 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7226 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007227
7228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7230
7231 Example :
7232 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7233 backend direct_forward
7234 option httpclose
7235 option http_proxy
7236
7237 See also : "option httpclose"
7238
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007239
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007240option independent-streams
7241no option independent-streams
7242 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7244 yes | yes | yes | yes
7245 Arguments : none
7246
7247 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7248 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7249 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7250 receive data or not.
7251
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007252 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007253 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7254 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7255 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7256 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7257 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7258 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7259 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7260 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7261 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7262 socket buffers.
7263
7264 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7265 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7266 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7267 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7268 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7269
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007270 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007271
7272
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007273option ldap-check
7274 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7276 yes | no | yes | yes
7277 Arguments : none
7278
7279 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7280 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7281 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7282 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7283
7284 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7285 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7286
7287 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7288 configure it.
7289
7290 Example :
7291 option ldap-check
7292
7293 See also : "option httpchk"
7294
7295
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007296option external-check
7297 Use external processes for server health checks
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 yes | no | yes | yes
7300
7301 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7302 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7303 command".
7304
7305 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7306
7307 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7308
7309
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007310option log-health-checks
7311no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007312 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7314 yes | no | yes | yes
7315 Arguments : none
7316
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007317 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7318 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7319 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007320
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007321 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7322 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7323 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7324 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7325 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7326
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007327 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007328 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007329
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007330 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7331 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7332 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007333
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007334
7335option log-separate-errors
7336no option log-separate-errors
7337 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7339 yes | yes | yes | no
7340 Arguments : none
7341
7342 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7343 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7344 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7345 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7346 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7347 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7348 provides very important information.
7349
7350 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7351 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7352 error logs.
7353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007354 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007355 logging.
7356
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007357
7358option logasap
7359no option logasap
7360 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7362 yes | yes | yes | no
7363 Arguments : none
7364
7365 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7366 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7367 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7368 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7369 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7370 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7371 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007372 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007373 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7374 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7375
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007376 Examples :
7377 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7378 mode http
7379 option httplog
7380 option logasap
7381 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7382
7383 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7384 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7385 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7386 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007388 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007389 logging.
7390
7391
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007392option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007393 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7395 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007396 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007397 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7398 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007399 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007400
7401 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7402 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007403 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007404 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7405 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7406 in the MySQL table, like this :
7407
7408 USE mysql;
7409 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7410 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7411
7412 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007413 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007414 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7415 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7416 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7417 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7418 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7419 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7420 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7421
7422 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7423 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007424
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007425 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007426
7427 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7428 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7429 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7430 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007431 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7432 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007433
7434 See also: "option httpchk"
7435
7436
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007437option nolinger
7438no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007439 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007440 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007442 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007443
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007444 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007445 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7446 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7447 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7448 connections.
7449
7450 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7451 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7452 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7453 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7454 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7455 this too.
7456
7457 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7458 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7459 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7460
7461 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7462 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7463 for servers.
7464
7465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7467
7468
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007469option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7470 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7472 yes | yes | yes | yes
7473 Arguments :
7474 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7475 matching <network>
7476 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7477 header name.
7478
7479 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7480 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7481 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7482 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7483 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7484 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7485 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7486 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7487 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7488 possible that the client has already brought one.
7489
7490 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7491 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7492 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7493 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7494 header and requires different one.
7495
7496 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7497 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7498 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7499 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7500 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7501 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7502 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7503
7504 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7505 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7506 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7507 both are defined.
7508
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007509 Examples :
7510 # Original Destination address
7511 frontend www
7512 mode http
7513 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7514
7515 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7516 backend www
7517 mode http
7518 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7519
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007520 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007521
7522
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007523option persist
7524no option persist
7525 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7527 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007528 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007529
7530 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7531 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7532 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7533 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7534 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7535 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7536 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7537 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7538 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7539 redirected to another valid server.
7540
7541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7543
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007544 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007545
7546
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007547option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7548 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7550 yes | no | yes | yes
7551 Arguments :
7552 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7553 PostgreSQL server.
7554
7555 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7556 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7557 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7558 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7559
7560 See also: "option httpchk"
7561
7562
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007563option prefer-last-server
7564no option prefer-last-server
7565 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7567 yes | no | yes | yes
7568 Arguments : none
7569
7570 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7571 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7572 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7573 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7574 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7575 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7576 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7577 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7578 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007579 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7580 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007581 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7582 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7583 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007584 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7585 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7586 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007587
7588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7590
7591 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7592
7593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007594option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007595option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007596no option redispatch
7597 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007600 Arguments :
7601 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7602 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7603 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007604 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007605 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007606 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007607 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7608 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7609 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007611
7612 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7613 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7614 be able to access the service anymore.
7615
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007616 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7617 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007618
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007619 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7620 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7621 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7622 following order:
7623
7624 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7625
7626 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7627 list, or
7628
7629 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7630
7631 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7632 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7633
7634 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7635 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7636 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7637 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7638
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007639 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007640 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7641 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007643 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7644 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7645
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007646 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007647
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007648
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007649option redis-check
7650 Use redis health checks for server testing
7651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7652 yes | no | yes | yes
7653 Arguments : none
7654
7655 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7656 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7657 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7658 find the "+PONG" response message.
7659
7660 Example :
7661 option redis-check
7662
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007663 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007664
7665
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007666option smtpchk
7667option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7668 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7670 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007671 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007672 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007673 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007674 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7675
7676 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7677 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7678 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7679
7680 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7681 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7682 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7683 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7684 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7685 dead server.
7686
7687 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7688 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007689 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007690 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7691
7692 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7693 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7694 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7695 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007696 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007697
7698 Example :
7699 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7700
7701 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007704option socket-stats
7705no option socket-stats
7706
7707 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7709 yes | yes | yes | no
7710
7711 Arguments : none
7712
7713
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007714option splice-auto
7715no option splice-auto
7716 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 yes | yes | yes | yes
7719 Arguments : none
7720
7721 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7722 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007723 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007724 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007725 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007726 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7727 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7728 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7729 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7730
7731 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7732 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7733 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7734 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7735 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7736 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7737 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7738 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7739 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7740 keyword.
7741
7742 Example :
7743 option splice-auto
7744
7745 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7746 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7747
7748 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7749 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7750
7751
7752option splice-request
7753no option splice-request
7754 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7756 yes | yes | yes | yes
7757 Arguments : none
7758
7759 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007760 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007761 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7762 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7763 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7764 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7765
7766 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7767
7768 Example :
7769 option splice-request
7770
7771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7773
7774 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7775 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7776
7777
7778option splice-response
7779no option splice-response
7780 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7782 yes | yes | yes | yes
7783 Arguments : none
7784
7785 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007786 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007787 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7788 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7789 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7790 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7791
7792 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7793
7794 Example :
7795 option splice-response
7796
7797 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7798 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7799
7800 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7801 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7802
7803
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007804option spop-check
7805 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7807 no | no | no | yes
7808 Arguments : none
7809
7810 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7811 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7812 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7813 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7814
7815 Example :
7816 option spop-check
7817
7818 See also : "option httpchk"
7819
7820
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007821option srvtcpka
7822no option srvtcpka
7823 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7825 yes | no | yes | yes
7826 Arguments : none
7827
7828 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7829 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007830 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007831 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7832
7833 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7834 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7835 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7836 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7837
7838 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7839 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7840 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7841 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7842 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7843
7844 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7845
7846 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7847 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7848 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7849
7850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7852
7853 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7854
7855
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007856option ssl-hello-chk
7857 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 yes | no | yes | yes
7860 Arguments : none
7861
7862 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7863 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7864 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7865 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7866 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7867 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7868 hello message.
7869
7870 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7871 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7872 messages, which is appreciable.
7873
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007874 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7875 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7876 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007877
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007878 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7879
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007880
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007881option tcp-check
7882 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7884 yes | no | yes | yes
7885
7886 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7887 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7888
7889 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7890 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7891 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7892
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007893 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007894 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7895 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7896 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7897 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7898 only.
7899
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007900 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007901 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7902 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7903 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7904 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7905
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007906 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007907 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7908 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007909 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007910 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7911 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7912 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7913 the respective protocols.
7914 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007915 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007916
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007917 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7918 script.
7919
7920 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7921 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7922 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7923 The "comment" is of course optional.
7924
7925
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007926 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007927 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007928 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007929 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007930
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007931 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007932 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007933 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007934
7935 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7936 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007937 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007938 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007939 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007940 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007941 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007942 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007943 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7944 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007945 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007946 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7947 tcp-check expect string +OK
7948
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007949 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007950 (send many headers before analyzing)
7951 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007952 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007953 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7954 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7955 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7956 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007957 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007958
7959
7960 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7961
7962
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007963option tcp-smart-accept
7964no option tcp-smart-accept
7965 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 yes | yes | yes | no
7968 Arguments : none
7969
7970 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7971 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7972 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7973 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7974 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7975 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7976
7977 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7978 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7979 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7980 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7981
7982 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7983 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7984 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007985 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007986
7987 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7988 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7989 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7990
7991 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7992 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7993 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7994
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007995 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7996
7997
7998option tcp-smart-connect
7999no option tcp-smart-connect
8000 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8002 yes | no | yes | yes
8003 Arguments : none
8004
8005 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8006 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8007 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8008 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8009 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8010
8011 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8012 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8013 complex.
8014
8015 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8016 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8017 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8018
8019 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8020 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8021
8022 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8023
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008024
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008025option tcpka
8026 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 yes | yes | yes | yes
8029 Arguments : none
8030
8031 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8032 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008033 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008034 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8035
8036 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8037 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8038 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8039 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8040
8041 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8042 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8043 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8044 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8045 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8046
8047 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8048
8049 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8050 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8051 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8052 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8053 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8054 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8055 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8056 backends.
8057
8058 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8059
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008060
8061option tcplog
8062 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008064 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008065 Arguments : none
8066
8067 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8068 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8069 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8070 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8071 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8072 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8073 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8074 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8075
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008076 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008078 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008079
8080
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008081option transparent
8082no option transparent
8083 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008085 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008086 Arguments : none
8087
8088 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8089 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8090 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8091 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8092 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8093 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8094 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8095 appropriate server.
8096
8097 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8098 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8099
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008100 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008101 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008102
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008103
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008104external-check command <command>
8105 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8107 yes | no | yes | yes
8108
8109 Arguments :
8110 <command> is the external command to run
8111
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008112 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8113
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008114 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008115
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008116 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8117 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8118 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8119 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8120 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8121 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008122
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008123 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8124
8125 Environment variables :
8126 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8127 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8128
8129 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8130
8131 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8132
8133 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8134 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8135 for a UNIX socket).
8136
8137 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8138
8139 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8140
8141 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8142
8143 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8144
8145 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8146
8147 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8148 socket).
8149
8150 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8151 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8152
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008153 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8154
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008155 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8156 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8157 failed.
8158
8159 Example :
8160 external-check command /bin/true
8161
8162 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8163
8164
8165external-check path <path>
8166 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8168 yes | no | yes | yes
8169
8170 Arguments :
8171 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8172
8173 The default path is "".
8174
8175 Example :
8176 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8177
8178 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8179 "external-check command"
8180
8181
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008182persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008183persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008184 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8186 yes | no | yes | yes
8187 Arguments :
8188 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008189 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8190 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008191
8192 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8193 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008194 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008195 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8196 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8197 forwarded to this server.
8198
8199 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8200 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8201 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008202 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008203 a single "listen" section.
8204
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008205 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8206 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8207 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8208
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008209 Example :
8210 listen tse-farm
8211 bind :3389
8212 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8213 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8214 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8215 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8216 persist rdp-cookie
8217 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008218 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008219 balance rdp-cookie
8220 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8221 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8222
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008223 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8224 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008225
8226
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008227rate-limit sessions <rate>
8228 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8230 yes | yes | yes | no
8231 Arguments :
8232 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8233 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8234
8235 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8236 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8237 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8238 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8239 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8240 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8241
8242 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8243 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8244 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8245 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8246
8247 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8248 listen smtp
8249 mode tcp
8250 bind :25
8251 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008252 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008253
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008254 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8255 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8256 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008257
8258 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8259
8260
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008261redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8262redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8263redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008264 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8266 no | yes | yes | yes
8267
8268 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008269 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008270
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008271 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008272 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008273 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8274 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8275 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008276
8277 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8278 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8279 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8280 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8281 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008282 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8283 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8284 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8285 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008286
8287 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8288 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8289 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8290 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8291 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8292 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008293 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008294 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008295 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8296 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8297 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008298
8299 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008300 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8301 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8302 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008303 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008304 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8305 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8306 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8307 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008308
8309 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008310 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008311
8312 - "drop-query"
8313 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8314 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8315 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8316 with a location-type redirect.
8317
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008318 - "append-slash"
8319 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8320 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8321 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8322 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8323
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008324 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8325 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8326 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8327 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8328 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8329 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8330 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8331
8332 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8333 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8334 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8335 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8336 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8337 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8338 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008339
8340 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8341 acl clear dst_port 80
8342 acl secure dst_port 8080
8343 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008344 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008345 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008346 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8347
8348 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008349 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8350 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8351 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008352 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008353
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008354 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8355 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8356 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8357
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008358 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008359 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008360
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008361 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008362 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8363 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8364 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008366 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008367
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008368
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008369retries <value>
8370 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8372 yes | no | yes | yes
8373 Arguments :
8374 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8375 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8376 default value is 3.
8377
8378 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8379 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8380 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8381
8382 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008383 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8384 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008385
8386 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8387 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8388
8389 See also : "option redispatch"
8390
8391
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008392retry-on [list of keywords]
8393 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8394 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8395 yes | no | yes | yes
8396 Arguments :
8397 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8398 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8399 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8400 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8401
8402 none never retry
8403
8404 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8405 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8406
8407 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8408 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8409 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8410 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8411 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8412 processing the request.
8413
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008414 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8415 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8416 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8417 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8418 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8419 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8420 overflow attack for example).
8421
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008422 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8423 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8424 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8425 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8426 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8427 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8428 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8429 amplify denial of service attacks.
8430
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008431 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8432 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8433 considered to be safe to retry.
8434
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008435 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8436 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8437 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8438 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8439
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008440 all-retryable-errors
8441 retry request for any error that are considered
8442 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8443 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8444 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8445
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008446 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8447 not cumulative.
8448
8449 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8450 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8451 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8452 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8453
8454 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8455 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8456 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8457 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8458 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8459 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8460 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8461 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8462 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8463 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8464 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8465 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8466
8467 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8468 should not use this directive.
8469
8470 The default is "conn-failure".
8471
8472 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8473
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008474server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008475 Declare a server in a backend
8476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8477 no | no | yes | yes
8478 Arguments :
8479 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008480 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008481 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008482
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008483 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8484 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8485 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8486 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008487 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8488 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8489 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8490 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8491 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008492 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8493 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8494 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8495 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8496 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8497 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8498 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008499 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008500 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8501 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8502 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8503 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8504 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8505 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008506 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8507 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008508 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8509 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008510
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008511 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008512 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8513 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8514 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8515 adding this value to the client's port.
8516
8517 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8518 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008519 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008520
8521 Examples :
8522 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8523 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008524 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008525 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8526 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8527 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008528
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008529 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8530 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8531 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8532 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8533 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8534
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008535 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8536 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008537
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008538server-state-file-name [<file>]
8539 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8540 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8541 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8542 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8543 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8544 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8545
8546 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8547 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8548
8549 global
8550 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8551
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008552 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008553 load-server-state-from-file
8554
8555 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8556 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008557
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008558server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8559 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8560 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8562 no | no | yes | yes
8563
8564 Arguments:
8565 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8566
8567 <num | range>
8568 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8569 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8570 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8571 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8572
8573 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8574
8575 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8576
8577 <params*>
8578 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8579 keyword.
8580
8581 Examples:
8582 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8583 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8584 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8585
8586 # or
8587 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8588
8589 # would be equivalent to:
8590 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8591 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8592 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8593
8594
8595
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008596source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008597source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008598source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008599 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8601 yes | no | yes | yes
8602 Arguments :
8603 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8604 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008605
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008606 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008607 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8608 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8609 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8610 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8611 supported prefixes are :
8612 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8613 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8614 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008615 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008616 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8617 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008618
8619 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8620 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008621 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8622 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8623 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008624
8625 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8626 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8627 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8628 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8629 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8630 <addr>.
8631
8632 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8633 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8634 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8635 port.
8636
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008637 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8638 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8639 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8640 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008641 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008642 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8643 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8644 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8645 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8646 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8647 HTTP header.
8648
8649 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8650 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008651 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008652 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8653 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8654 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8655 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8656 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8657 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8658 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8659
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008660 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8661 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8662 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8663 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8664 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8665 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8666
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008667 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8668 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8669 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8670 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8671
8672 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8673 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8674 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8675 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8676 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8677 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8678
8679 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8680 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8681 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8682 there are two methods :
8683
8684 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8685 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8686 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8687 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8688 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8689 of the client ranges may be used.
8690
8691 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8692 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8693 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8694 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8695 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8696 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8697 same session.
8698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008699 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8700 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8701 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008702 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008703
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008704 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8705
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008706 Examples :
8707 backend private
8708 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8709 source 192.168.1.200
8710
8711 backend transparent_ssl1
8712 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8713 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8714
8715 backend transparent_ssl2
8716 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8717 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8718 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8719
8720 backend transparent_ssl3
8721 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8722 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8723 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8724
8725 backend transparent_smtp
8726 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8727 # with Tproxy version 4.
8728 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8729
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008730 backend transparent_http
8731 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8732 # proxy.
8733 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008735 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008736 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8737
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008738
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008739stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8740 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008742 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008743
8744 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8745 matched.
8746
8747 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8748 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8749
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008750 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8751 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008752 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008753
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008754 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8755 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8756 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8757 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008758
8759 Example :
8760 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8761 backend stats_localhost
8762 stats enable
8763 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8764
8765 Example :
8766 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8767 backend stats_auth
8768 stats enable
8769 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8770 stats admin if TRUE
8771
8772 Example :
8773 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8774 userlist stats-auth
8775 group admin users admin
8776 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8777 group readonly users haproxy
8778 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8779
8780 backend stats_auth
8781 stats enable
8782 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8783 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8784 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8785 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8786
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008787 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8788 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8789 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008790
8791
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008792stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8793 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008795 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008796 Arguments :
8797 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8798
8799 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8800
8801 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8802 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8803 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8804 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8805 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8806 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8807
8808 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8809 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8810 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008811 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008812
8813 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8814 report using "stats scope".
8815
8816 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8817 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8818 unobvious parameters.
8819
8820 Example :
8821 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8822 backend public_www
8823 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8824 stats enable
8825 stats hide-version
8826 stats scope .
8827 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008828 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008829 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8830 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8831
8832 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8833 backend private_monitoring
8834 stats enable
8835 stats uri /admin?stats
8836 stats refresh 5s
8837
8838 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8839
8840
8841stats enable
8842 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008844 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008845 Arguments : none
8846
8847 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8848 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8849 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8850 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8851 - stats auth : no authentication
8852 - stats scope : no restriction
8853
8854 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8855 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8856 unobvious parameters.
8857
8858 Example :
8859 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8860 backend public_www
8861 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8862 stats enable
8863 stats hide-version
8864 stats scope .
8865 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008866 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008867 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8868 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8869
8870 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8871 backend private_monitoring
8872 stats enable
8873 stats uri /admin?stats
8874 stats refresh 5s
8875
8876 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8877
8878
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008879stats hide-version
8880 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008882 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008883 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008884
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008885 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8886 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8887 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8888 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8889 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8890 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008892 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8893 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8894 unobvious parameters.
8895
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008896 Example :
8897 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8898 backend public_www
8899 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008900 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008901 stats hide-version
8902 stats scope .
8903 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008904 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008905 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8906 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008907
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008908 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8909 backend private_monitoring
8910 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008911 stats uri /admin?stats
8912 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008913
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008914 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008915
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008916
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008917stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8918 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8919 Access control for statistics
8920
8921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8922 no | no | yes | yes
8923
8924 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8925 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8926 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8927 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8928 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8929 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8930
8931 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8932 instance.
8933
8934 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8935 about ACL usage.
8936
8937
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008938stats realm <realm>
8939 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008941 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008942 Arguments :
8943 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8944 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8945 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8946
8947 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8948 using a backslash ('\').
8949
8950 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8951 only related to authentication.
8952
8953 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8954 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8955 unobvious parameters.
8956
8957 Example :
8958 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8959 backend public_www
8960 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8961 stats enable
8962 stats hide-version
8963 stats scope .
8964 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008965 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008966 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8967 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8968
8969 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8970 backend private_monitoring
8971 stats enable
8972 stats uri /admin?stats
8973 stats refresh 5s
8974
8975 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8976
8977
8978stats refresh <delay>
8979 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008981 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008982 Arguments :
8983 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8984 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8985 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8986 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8987 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8988 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8989
8990 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8991 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8992 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8993 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8994
8995 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8996 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8997 unobvious parameters.
8998
8999 Example :
9000 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9001 backend public_www
9002 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9003 stats enable
9004 stats hide-version
9005 stats scope .
9006 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009007 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009008 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9009 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9010
9011 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9012 backend private_monitoring
9013 stats enable
9014 stats uri /admin?stats
9015 stats refresh 5s
9016
9017 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9018
9019
9020stats scope { <name> | "." }
9021 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009023 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009024 Arguments :
9025 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9026 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9027 section in which the statement appears.
9028
9029 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9030 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9031 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9032 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9033 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9034 exists.
9035
9036 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9037 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9038 unobvious parameters.
9039
9040 Example :
9041 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9042 backend public_www
9043 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9044 stats enable
9045 stats hide-version
9046 stats scope .
9047 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009048 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009049 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9050 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9051
9052 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9053 backend private_monitoring
9054 stats enable
9055 stats uri /admin?stats
9056 stats refresh 5s
9057
9058 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9059
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009060
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009061stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009062 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009064 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009065
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009066 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009067 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9068
9069 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9070 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9071
9072 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9073 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009074 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009075
9076 Example :
9077 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9078 backend private_monitoring
9079 stats enable
9080 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9081 stats uri /admin?stats
9082 stats refresh 5s
9083
9084 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9085 global section.
9086
9087
9088stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009089 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9091 yes | yes | yes | yes
9092 Arguments : none
9093
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009094 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009095 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9096 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9097 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9098 - IP (socket, server)
9099 - cookie (backend, server)
9100
9101 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9102 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009103 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009104
9105 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9106
9107
9108stats show-node [ <name> ]
9109 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009111 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009112 Arguments:
9113 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9114 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9115
9116 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9117 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009118 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009119
9120 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9121 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9122 unobvious parameters.
9123
9124 Example:
9125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9126 backend private_monitoring
9127 stats enable
9128 stats show-node Europe-1
9129 stats uri /admin?stats
9130 stats refresh 5s
9131
9132 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9133 section.
9134
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009135
9136stats uri <prefix>
9137 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009139 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009140 Arguments :
9141 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9142 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9143 query string.
9144
9145 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9146 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9147 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9148 possible to reach it in the application.
9149
9150 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009151 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009152 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9153 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9154 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9155 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9156
9157 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9158 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9159 an address or a port to statistics only.
9160
9161 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9162 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9163 unobvious parameters.
9164
9165 Example :
9166 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9167 backend public_www
9168 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9169 stats enable
9170 stats hide-version
9171 stats scope .
9172 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009173 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009174 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9175 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9176
9177 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9178 backend private_monitoring
9179 stats enable
9180 stats uri /admin?stats
9181 stats refresh 5s
9182
9183 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9184
9185
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009186stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9187 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009189 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009190
9191 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009192 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009193 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009194 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009195 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9196
9197 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9198 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9199 the "stick-table" statement.
9200
9201 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9202 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9203 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9204 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9205 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9206
9207 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9208 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9209 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9210 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9211 transformation rules.
9212
9213 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9214 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9215 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9216 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9217 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9218 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9219 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9220
9221 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9222 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9223 ACL based conditions.
9224
9225 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9226 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9227 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9228 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9229
9230 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9231 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9232 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9233 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9234
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009235 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9236 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009237 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009238
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009239 Example :
9240 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9241 # last 30 minutes
9242 backend pop
9243 mode tcp
9244 balance roundrobin
9245 stick store-request src
9246 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9247 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9248 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9249
9250 backend smtp
9251 mode tcp
9252 balance roundrobin
9253 stick match src table pop
9254 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9255 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9256
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009257 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009258 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009259
9260
9261stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9262 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9264 no | no | yes | yes
9265
9266 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9267 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9268 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9269 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9270
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009271 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9272 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009273 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009274
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009275 Examples :
9276 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009277 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009278
9279 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9280 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9281 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9282
9283
9284 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9285 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9286 backend http
9287 mode http
9288 balance roundrobin
9289 stick on src table https
9290 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9291 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9292 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9293
9294 backend https
9295 mode tcp
9296 balance roundrobin
9297 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9298 stick on src
9299 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9300 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9301
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009302 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009303
9304
9305stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9306 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9308 no | no | yes | yes
9309
9310 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009311 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009312 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009313 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009314 server is selected.
9315
9316 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9317 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9318 the "stick-table" statement.
9319
9320 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9321 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9322 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9323 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9324 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9325 address.
9326
9327 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9328 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9329 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9330 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9331 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9332 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9333 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9334 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9335 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9336 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9337
9338 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9339 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9340 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9341 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9342 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9343 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9344 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9345
9346 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9347 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9348 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9349 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9350
9351 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9352 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9353 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9354 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9355 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9356 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009357 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9358 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9359 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9360 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9361 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9362 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009363
9364 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9365 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9366 the request.
9367
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009368 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9369 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009370 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009371
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009372 Example :
9373 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9374 # last 30 minutes
9375 backend pop
9376 mode tcp
9377 balance roundrobin
9378 stick store-request src
9379 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9380 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9381 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9382
9383 backend smtp
9384 mode tcp
9385 balance roundrobin
9386 stick match src table pop
9387 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9388 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9389
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009390 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009391 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009392
9393
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009394stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009395 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9396 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009397 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009399 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009400
9401 Arguments :
9402 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9403 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9404 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9405 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9406
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009407 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9408 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9409 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9410 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9411
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009412 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9413 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9414 instance.
9415
9416 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9417 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9418 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9419 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9420 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9421 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009422 to 32 characters.
9423
9424 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9425 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9426 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009427 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009428 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9429 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009430
9431 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009432 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9433 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009434 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9435 increase.
9436
9437 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009438 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9439 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9440 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009441
9442 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9443 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9444 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9445 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009446 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009447 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9448 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9449 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9450 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9451 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9452 parameter (see below).
9453
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009454 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9455 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9456 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9457 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9458 soft restart.
9459
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009460 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9461 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009462
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009463 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9464 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9465 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9466 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009467 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009468 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009469 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9470 if not expiration delay is specified.
9471
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009472 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9473 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9474 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9475 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009476 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9477 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9478 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9479 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9480 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9481 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9482 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9483 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9484 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9485 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9486 types and their arguments.
9487
9488 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9489 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9490 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9491 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9492
9493 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9494 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9495 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009496 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009497
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009498 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9499 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9500 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009501 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009502 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009503 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009504
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009505 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9506 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9507 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9508 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9509
9510 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9511 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9512 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9513 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9514 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9515 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9516
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009517 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9518 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9519 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9520 they were received.
9521
9522 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9523 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9524 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9525 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9526 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9527
9528 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9529 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9530 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9531 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9532 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9533
9534 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9535 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9536 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9537
9538 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9539 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9540 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9541 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9542 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9543
9544 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9545 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9546 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9547 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9548 the client side.
9549
9550 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9551 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9552 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9553 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9554 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9555 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9556 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9557
9558 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9559 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9560 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9561 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9562 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9563 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009564 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009565
9566 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9567 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9568 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9569 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9570 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9571 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9572
9573 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009574 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009575 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9576 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9577
9578 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9579 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9580 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9581 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9582 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9583 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9584 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9585 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9586 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9587 recommended for better fairness.
9588
9589 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009590 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009591 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9592 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9593
9594 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9595 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9596 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9597 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9598 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9599 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9600 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9601 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9602 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9603 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009604
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009605 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9606 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009607 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9608 reference it.
9609
9610 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9611 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009612 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9613 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9614 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009615
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009616 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9617 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9618 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9619 something that can be ignored.
9620
9621 Example:
9622 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9623 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9624 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9625 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9626
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009627 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009628 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009629
9630
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009631stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009632 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9634 no | no | yes | yes
9635
9636 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009637 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009638 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009639 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009640 server is selected.
9641
9642 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9643 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9644 the "stick-table" statement.
9645
9646 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9647 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9648 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9649 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9650
9651 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9652 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9653 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9654 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9655 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9656 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009657 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009658 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9659 rules.
9660
9661 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9662 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9663 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9664 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9665 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9666 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9667 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9668
9669 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9670 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9671 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9672 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9673
9674 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9675 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9676 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9677 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9678 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9679 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009680 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9681 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9682 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9683 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9684 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9685 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9686 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9687 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9688 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009689
9690 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9691
9692 Example :
9693 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9694 backend https
9695 mode tcp
9696 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009697 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009698 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009699
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009700 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9701 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9702
9703 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9704 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9705 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9706
9707 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9708 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009709
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009710 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9711 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9712 # at offset 44.
9713
9714 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9715 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9716
9717 # Learn on response if server hello.
9718 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009719
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009720 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9721 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9722
9723 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9724 extraction.
9725
9726
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009727tcp-check connect [params*]
9728 Opens a new connection
9729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9730 no | no | yes | yes
9731
9732 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9733 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9734 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9735
9736 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9737 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9738 of the sequence.
9739
9740 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9741 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9742 do.
9743
9744 Parameters :
9745 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9746 use the TCP connection.
9747
9748 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9749 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9750 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9751
9752 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9753
9754 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9755
9756 Examples:
9757 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9758 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9759 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9760 option tcp-check
9761 tcp-check connect
9762 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9763 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9764 tcp-check send \r\n
9765 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9766 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9767 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9768 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9769 tcp-check send \r\n
9770 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9771 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9772
9773 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9774 option tcp-check
9775 tcp-check connect port 110
9776 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9777 tcp-check connect port 143
9778 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9779 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9780
9781 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9782
9783
9784tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009785 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9787 no | no | yes | yes
9788
9789 Arguments :
9790 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9791 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9792 binary.
9793 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9794 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9795 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9796
9797 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9798 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9799 with the usual backslash ('\').
9800 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009801 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009802 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9803 used upper or lower case.
9804
9805
9806 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9807
9808 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9809 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9810 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9811 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9812 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9813 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9814 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9815 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9816
9817 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9818 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9819 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9820 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9821 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9822 expression.
9823
9824 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9825 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9826 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9827 this exact hexadecimal string.
9828 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9829
9830 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9831 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9832 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9833 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9834 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9835 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9836 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9837 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9838 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9839 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9840 the null character.
9841
9842 Examples :
9843 # perform a POP check
9844 option tcp-check
9845 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9846
9847 # perform an IMAP check
9848 option tcp-check
9849 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9850
9851 # look for the redis master server
9852 option tcp-check
9853 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009854 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009855 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9856 tcp-check expect string role:master
9857 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9858 tcp-check expect string +OK
9859
9860
9861 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9862 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9863
9864
9865tcp-check send <data>
9866 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9868 no | no | yes | yes
9869
9870 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9871 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9872
9873 Examples :
9874 # look for the redis master server
9875 option tcp-check
9876 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9877 tcp-check expect string role:master
9878
9879 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9880 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9881
9882
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009883tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9884 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009885 tcp health check
9886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9887 no | no | yes | yes
9888
9889 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9890 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009891 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009892 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9893 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9894 hexadecimal string.
9895 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9896
9897 Examples :
9898 # redis check in binary
9899 option tcp-check
9900 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9901 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9902
9903
9904 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9905 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9906
9907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009908tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9909 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9911 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009913 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9914 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009916 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009917
9918 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9919 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009920 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9921 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9922 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9923 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9924 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9925 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009927 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9928 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9929 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9930 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009931
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009932 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009933 - accept :
9934 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9935 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9936 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009938 - reject :
9939 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9940 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9941 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9942 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9943 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9944 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9945 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9946 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9947 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9948 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9949 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009950 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009951
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009952 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9953 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9954 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9955 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9956 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9957 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9958 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9959 hosts.
9960
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009961 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9962 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9963 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9964 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9965 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9966 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9967 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9968 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9969
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009970 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9971 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9972 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9973 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9974 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9975 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9976 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9977 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9978 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009979 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9980 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009981
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009982 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009983 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009984 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9985 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9986 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009987 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009988 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9989 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9990 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9991 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9992 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9993 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9994 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9995 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009997 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009998 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009999 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010000 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010001 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10002 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10003 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010005 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10006 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10007 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10008 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010010 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10011 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10012 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10013 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10014 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010015 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10016 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10017 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10018 layer7 information is extracted.
10019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010020 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10021 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10022 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10023 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10024 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010025
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010026 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10027 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10028 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10029 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10030
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010031 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10032 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10033 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10034 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10035
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010036 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10037 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10038 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10039 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10040 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010041
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010042 - set-src <expr> :
10043 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10044 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10045 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010046 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010048 Arguments:
10049 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10050 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010051
10052 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010053 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10054
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010055 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10056 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010057
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010058 - set-src-port <expr> :
10059 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10060 expression.
10061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010062 Arguments:
10063 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10064 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010065
10066 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010067 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10068
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010069 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10070 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10071 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010072
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010073 - set-dst <expr> :
10074 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10075 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10076 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10077 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10078 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10079
10080 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10081 followed by some converters.
10082
10083 Example:
10084
10085 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10086 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10087
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010088 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10089 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10090
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010091 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10092 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10093 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10094 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10095
10096
10097 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10098 followed by some converters.
10099
10100 Example:
10101
10102 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10103
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010104 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10105 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10106 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10107
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010108 - "silent-drop" :
10109 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010110 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010111 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10112 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10113 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10114 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10115 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010116 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10117 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010118 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10119 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010120 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010121 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10122 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10123 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10124 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010126 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10127 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10128 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10131 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10132 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010134 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010135 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010136 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010138 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10139 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10140 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010142 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010143 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10144 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010145
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010146 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10147
10148 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10149
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010150 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10151
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010152 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010153
10154
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010155tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10156 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010158 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010159 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010160 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10161 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010163 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010164
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010165 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010166 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10167 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10168 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10169 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010170
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010171 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10172 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10173 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10174 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010175 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10176 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10177 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10178 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10179 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10180 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010181 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010182 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010183
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010184 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10185 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10186 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10187 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010188
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010189 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010190 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010191 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010192 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10193 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010194 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010195 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010196 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010197 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010198 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010199 - set-dst <expr>
10200 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010201 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010202 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010203 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010204 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010205 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010206
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010207 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10208 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010209 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10210 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010211
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010212 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10213 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10214 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10215 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10216 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10217 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010219 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010220 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10221 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010223 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010224 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10225 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10226 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10227 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010228 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10229 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10230 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010231
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010232 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010233 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10234 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10235 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010236
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010237 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10238 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10239
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010240 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010241 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10242 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010243
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010244 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10245 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010246 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010247 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10248 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010249 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010250 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010251 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010252 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10253 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010254 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010255 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10256 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010257
10258 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10259 followed by some converters.
10260
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010261 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10262 <var-name>.
10263
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010264 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10265 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10266 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10267 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10268 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10269
10270 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10271 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10272 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10273 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10274 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10275 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10276 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10277 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10278 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10279 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10280 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10281
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010282 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10283 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10284 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10285 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10286 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10287
10288 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10289
10290 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10291
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010292 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10293 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10294 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10295 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10296 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10297 evaluated.
10298
10299 Example:
10300 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10301
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010302 Example:
10303
10304 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010305 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010306
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010307 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010308 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10309 # and reject everything else.
10310 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10311 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010312 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010313 tcp-request content reject
10314
10315 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010316 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10317 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10318 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010319 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010320
10321 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10322 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10323 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010324 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010325 tcp-request content reject
10326
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010327 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010328 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010329 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010330 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010331 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10332 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010333
10334 Example:
10335 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10336 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010337 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010338
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010339 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010340 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010341
10342 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010343 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010344 # protecting all our sites
10345 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010346 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10347 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010348 ...
10349 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10350
10351 backend http_dynamic
10352 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010353 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010354 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010355 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010356 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010357 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010358 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010360 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010361
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010362 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10363 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010364
10365
10366tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10367 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010369 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010370 Arguments :
10371 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10372 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10373 as explained at the top of this document.
10374
10375 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10376 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10377 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10378 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10379 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10380
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010381 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10382 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10383 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10384 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10385
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010386 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10387 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010388 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010389 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010390 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10391 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10392 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10393 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010394
10395 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10396 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10397 it pass through unaffected.
10398
10399 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10400 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10401 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010402 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010403 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10404 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010405 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10406 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10407 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010408
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010409 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010410 "timeout client".
10411
10412
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010413tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10414 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10416 no | no | yes | yes
10417 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010418 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10419 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010420
10421 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10422
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010423 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010424 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10425 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010426 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10427 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010428
10429 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10430
10431 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10432 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10433 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10434 inserted.
10435
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010436 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010437 - accept :
10438 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10439 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10440 the rules evaluation.
10441
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010442 - close :
10443 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10444 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10445 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10446 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10447 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10448 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010449 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010450 protocols.
10451
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010452 - reject :
10453 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10454 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010455 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010456
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010457 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10458 Sets a variable.
10459
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010460 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10461 Unsets a variable.
10462
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010463 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10464 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10465 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10466 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10467
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010468 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10469 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10470 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10471 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10472
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010473 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10474 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10475 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10476 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10477 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010478
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010479 - "silent-drop" :
10480 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010481 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010482 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10483 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10484 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10485 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10486 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010487 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10488 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010489 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10490 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010491 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010492 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10493 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10494 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10495 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10496
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010497 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10498 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10499
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010500 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10501 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10502 for changing the default action to a reject.
10503
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010504 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10505 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10506 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10507 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010508 period.
10509
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010510 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10511 declared inline.
10512
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010513 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10514 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010515 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010516 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10517 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010518 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010519 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010520 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010521 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10522 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010523 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010524 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10525 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010526
10527 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10528 followed by some converters.
10529
10530 Example:
10531
10532 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10533
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010534 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10535 <var-name>.
10536
10537 Example:
10538
10539 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10540
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010541 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10542 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10543 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10544 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10545 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10546
10547 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10548
10549 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10550
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010551 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10552
10553 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10554
10555
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010556tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10557 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10559 no | yes | yes | no
10560 Arguments :
10561 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10562 below.
10563
10564 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10565
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010566 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010567 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10568 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10569 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10570 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10571 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10572 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10573 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010574 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010575 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10576 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10577 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10578 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10579 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10580 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10581 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10582 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10583 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10584 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10585 instead.
10586
10587 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10588 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10589 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10590 rules which may be inserted.
10591
10592 Several types of actions are supported :
10593 - accept : the request is accepted
10594 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10595 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10596 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010597 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010598 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010599 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010600 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010601 - silent-drop
10602
10603 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10604 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10605 sections for a complete description.
10606
10607 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10608 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10609 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10610
10611 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10612 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10613 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10614 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10615 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10616
10617 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10618 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10619
10620 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10621 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10622 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10623
10624 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10625 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10626 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10627
10628 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10629 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10630 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10631
10632 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10633 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10634 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10635
10636 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10637
10638 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10639
10640
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010641tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10642 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10644 no | no | yes | yes
10645 Arguments :
10646 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10647 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10648 as explained at the top of this document.
10649
10650 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10651
10652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010653timeout check <timeout>
10654 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10655 established.
10656
10657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10658 yes | no | yes | yes
10659 Arguments:
10660 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10661 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10662 as explained at the top of this document.
10663
10664 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10665 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010666 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010667 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010668 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10669 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10670 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010671
10672 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10673 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10674
10675 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10676 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010677 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010678
10679 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10680 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10681 forget about it.
10682
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010683 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10684 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010685
10686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010687timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010688 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10690 yes | yes | yes | no
10691 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010692 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010693 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10694 as explained at the top of this document.
10695
10696 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10697 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10698 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010699 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10700 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10701 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10702 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010703 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10704 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10705 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010706 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010707 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010708 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10709 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010710 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10711 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010712
10713 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10714 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10715 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10716 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010717 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010718 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10719
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010720 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010721
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010722 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010724
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010725timeout client-fin <timeout>
10726 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10728 yes | yes | yes | no
10729 Arguments :
10730 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10731 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10732 as explained at the top of this document.
10733
10734 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10735 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10736 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10737 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10738 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10739 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10740 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010741 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10742 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10743 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010744
10745 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10746 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10747 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10748
10749 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10750
10751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010752timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010753 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10755 yes | no | yes | yes
10756 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010757 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010758 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10759 as explained at the top of this document.
10760
10761 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010762 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010763 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010764 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010765 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10766 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010767
10768 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10769 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10770 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10771 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010772 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010773 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10774
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010775 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010776
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010777
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010778timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10779 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10781 yes | yes | yes | yes
10782 Arguments :
10783 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10784 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10785 as explained at the top of this document.
10786
10787 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10788 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10789 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10790 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10791 once the request has started to present itself.
10792
10793 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10794 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10795 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10796 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10797 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10798
10799 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10800 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10801 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10802 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10803
10804 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10805 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010806 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010807 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10808 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010809 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010810
10811 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10812 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10813 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10814 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10815
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010816 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10817 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010818 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10819
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010820 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10821
10822
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010823timeout http-request <timeout>
10824 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010826 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010827 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010828 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010829 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10830 as explained at the top of this document.
10831
10832 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10833 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10834 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10835 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10836 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10837 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10838 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010839 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10840 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10841 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10842 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010843 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010844 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10845 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010846
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010847 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10848 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10849 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10850 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10851 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010852 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010853
10854 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10855 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010856 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010857 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10858 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10859
10860 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010861 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10862 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10863 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010864
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010865 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010866 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010867
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010868
10869timeout queue <timeout>
10870 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10872 yes | no | yes | yes
10873 Arguments :
10874 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10875 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10876 as explained at the top of this document.
10877
10878 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10879 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10880 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10881 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10882 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10883
10884 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10885 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10886 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10887 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10888
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010889 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010890
10891
10892timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010893 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10895 yes | no | yes | yes
10896 Arguments :
10897 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10898 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10899 as explained at the top of this document.
10900
10901 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10902 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10903 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10904 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10905 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10906 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10907 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10908
10909 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10910 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10911 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10912 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10913 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010914 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010915 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010916 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10917 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010918 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10919 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010920
10921 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10922 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10923 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10924 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010925 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010926 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10927
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010928 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010929
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010930
10931timeout server-fin <timeout>
10932 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10934 yes | no | yes | yes
10935 Arguments :
10936 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10938 as explained at the top of this document.
10939
10940 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10941 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10942 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10943 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10944 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10945 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10946 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10947 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10948 situations, it should not be needed.
10949
10950 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10951 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10952 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10953
10954 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10955
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010956
10957timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010958 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10960 yes | yes | yes | yes
10961 Arguments :
10962 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10963 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10964 as explained at the top of this document.
10965
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010966 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10967 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10968 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010969
10970 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10971 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10972 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10973 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010974 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010975
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010976 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010977
10978
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010979timeout tunnel <timeout>
10980 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10982 yes | no | yes | yes
10983 Arguments :
10984 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10985 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10986 as explained at the top of this document.
10987
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010988 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010989 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10990 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10991 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010992 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10993 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010994 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10995 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10996 specified.
10997
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010998 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10999 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11000 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11001 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11002 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11003 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11004 state.
11005
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011006 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11007 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11008 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11009 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011011
11012 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11013 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11014 forget about it.
11015
11016 Example :
11017 defaults http
11018 option http-server-close
11019 timeout connect 5s
11020 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011021 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011022 timeout server 30s
11023 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11024
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011025 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011026
11027
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011028transparent (deprecated)
11029 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011031 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011032 Arguments : none
11033
11034 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11035 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11036 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11037 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11038 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11039 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11040 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11041 appropriate server.
11042
11043 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11044
11045 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11046 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11047
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011048 See also: "option transparent"
11049
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011050unique-id-format <string>
11051 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11053 yes | yes | yes | no
11054 Arguments :
11055 <string> is a log-format string.
11056
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011057 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11058 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11059 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11060 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011061
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011062 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11063 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11064 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11065 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11066 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11067 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11068 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11069 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011070
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011071 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11072 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011073
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011074 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011075
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011076 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011077
11078 will generate:
11079
11080 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11081
11082 See also: "unique-id-header"
11083
11084unique-id-header <name>
11085 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11087 yes | yes | yes | no
11088 Arguments :
11089 <name> is the name of the header.
11090
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011091 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11092 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011093
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011094 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011095
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011096 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011097 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11098
11099 will generate:
11100
11101 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11102
11103 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011104
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011105use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011106 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11108 no | yes | yes | no
11109 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011110 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11111 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011112
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011113 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11114 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011115
11116 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11117 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11118 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011119 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011120 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011121 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11122 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011123
11124 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11125 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11126 assign the backend.
11127
11128 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11129 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11130 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11131 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11132 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11133 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11134
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011135 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011136 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011137 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11138 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11139 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11140
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011141 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11142 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11143 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11144 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11145 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11146 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11147 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11148 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11149 cannot be forced from the request.
11150
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011151 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011152 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11153 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11154
11155 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11156 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011157
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011158use-fcgi-app <name>
11159 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11161 no | no | yes | yes
11162 Arguments :
11163 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11164
11165 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011166
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011167use-server <server> if <condition>
11168use-server <server> unless <condition>
11169 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11171 no | no | yes | yes
11172 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011173 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11174 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011175
11176 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11177
11178 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11179 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11180 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11181
11182 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11183 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11184 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11185 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11186 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11187 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11188 matches will assign the server.
11189
11190 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11191 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11192 with the next rules until one matches.
11193
11194 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11195 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11196 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11197 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11198
11199 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11200 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11201 stripped.
11202
11203 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11204 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11205 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11206 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11207
11208 Example :
11209 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11210 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11211 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11212 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11213 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11214 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011215 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011216 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11217 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11218
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011219 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11220 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11221 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11222 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11223 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11224 and we fall back to load balancing.
11225
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011226 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011227
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011228
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100112295. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011230--------------------------
11231
11232The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11233depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11234settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11235written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11236described in this section.
11237
11238
112395.1. Bind options
11240-----------------
11241
11242The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11243as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11244no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11245parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11246while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11247provided immediately after the setting name.
11248
11249The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11250
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011251accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11252 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11253 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11254 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11255 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11256 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11257 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11258 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11259 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11260 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011261 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11262 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11263 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011265accept-proxy
11266 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011267 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11268 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011269 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11270 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11271 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11272 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011273 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011274 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11275 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011276 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11277 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011278
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011279allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011280 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011281 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011282 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011283 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11284 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011285
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011286alpn <protocols>
11287 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11288 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11289 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011290 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011291 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011292 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11293 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11294 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11295 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11296 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11297 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11298 preference, like below :
11299
11300 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011301
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011302backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011303 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011304 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11305
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011306curves <curves>
11307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11308 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11309 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11310 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11311 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11312 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11313
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011314ecdhe <named curve>
11315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011316 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11317 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011318
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011319ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11321 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11322 client's certificate.
11323
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011324ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11326 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11327 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11328 error is ignored.
11329
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011330ca-sign-file <cafile>
11331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11332 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11333 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11334 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11335 'generate-certificates' for details.
11336
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011337ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11339 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11340 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11341 'generate-certificates' for details.
11342
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011343ca-verify-file <cafile>
11344 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11345 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11346 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11347 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11348 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11349
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011350ciphers <ciphers>
11351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11352 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011353 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011354 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011355 information and recommendations see e.g.
11356 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11357 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11358 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11359
11360ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11362 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11363 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11364 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011365 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11366 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011367
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011368crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11370 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11371 to verify client's certificate.
11372
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011373crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011374 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11375 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11376 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11377 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11378 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011379 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11380 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011381
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011382 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11383 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11384
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011385 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11386 are loaded.
11387
11388 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011389 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11390 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11391 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11392 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11393 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11394 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11395 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011396 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011397
11398 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11399 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11400 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11401 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011402 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11403 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011404
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011405 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011406
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011407 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011408 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011409 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11410 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011411 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11412 clients).
11413
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011414 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11415 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11416 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11417 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11418 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11419 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11420 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11421 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11422 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11423 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11424 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11425 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11426 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11427
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011428 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11429 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11430 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11431 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11432 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11433
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011434 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11435 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11436 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11437 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011438
11439 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11440 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11441 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11442 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11443 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11444 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11445 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11446 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11447 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11448
11449 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11450
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011451 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011452 a cert bundle.
11453
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011454 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011455 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11456 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11457 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11458 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11459 provide multi-cert support.
11460
11461 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11462
11463 Filename | CN | SAN
11464 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11465 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011466 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011467 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11468 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11469
11470 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11471 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11472 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11473 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011474 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11475 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11476 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011477
11478 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11479 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11480
11481 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11482 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11483 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11484
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011485crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011487 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011488 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011489 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011490
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011491crt-list <file>
11492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011493 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11494 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011495
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011496 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11497
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011498 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11499 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11500 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11501 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011502
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011503 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11504 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11505 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11506 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11507 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11508 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11509 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11510 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011511
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011512 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011513 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011514 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11515 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11516 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011517
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011518 crt-list file example:
11519 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011520 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011521 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011522 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011523
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011524defer-accept
11525 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11526 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11527 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011528 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011529 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11530 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11531 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11532 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11533 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11534 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11535 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11536
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011537expose-fd listeners
11538 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11539 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011540 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11541 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011542 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011543
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011544force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011545 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011546 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011547 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011548 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011549
11550force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011551 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011552 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011553 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011554
11555force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011556 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011557 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011558 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011559
11560force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011561 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011562 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011563 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011564
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011565force-tlsv13
11566 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11567 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011568 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011569
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011570generate-certificates
11571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11572 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11573 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11574 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11575 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11576 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11577 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11578 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11579 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11580 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11581 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11582
11583 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11584 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011585 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011586 certificate is used many times.
11587
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011588gid <gid>
11589 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11590 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11591 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11592 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11593 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11594
11595group <group>
11596 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11597 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11598 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11599 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11600 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11601
11602id <id>
11603 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11604 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11605 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11606 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11607
11608interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011609 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11610 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11611 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11612 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11613 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11614 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011615 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11616 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11617 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11618 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11619 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11620 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011621
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011622level <level>
11623 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11624 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11625 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011626 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011627 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11628 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11629 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011630 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011631 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011632 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011633 all counters).
11634
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011635severity-output <format>
11636 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11637 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11638 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11639 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11640 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11641 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11642 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11643 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11644 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11645 rfc5424 convention.
11646
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011647maxconn <maxconn>
11648 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11649 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11650 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11651 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11652 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11653 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11654 eat all memory.
11655
11656mode <mode>
11657 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11658 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11659 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11660 UNIX sockets.
11661
11662mss <maxseg>
11663 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11664 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11665 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11666 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11667 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11668 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11669 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11670 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11671 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11672 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11673 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11674
11675name <name>
11676 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11677 page.
11678
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011679namespace <name>
11680 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11681 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11682 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11683 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11684
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011685nice <nice>
11686 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11687 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11688 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11689 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11690 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11691 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11692 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11693 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11694 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11695 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11696 one for an RDP socket.
11697
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011698no-ca-names
11699 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11700 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011701 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011702
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011703no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011705 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011706 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011707 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011708 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11709 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011710
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011711no-tls-tickets
11712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11713 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11714 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011715 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11716 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011717 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11718 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11719 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011720
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011721no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011723 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011724 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011725 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011726 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11727 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011728
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011729no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011731 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011732 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011733 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011734 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11735 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011736
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011737no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011738 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011739 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011740 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011741 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011742 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11743 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011744
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011745no-tlsv13
11746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11747 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11748 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11749 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011750 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11751 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011752
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011753npn <protocols>
11754 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11755 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11756 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011757 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011758 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011759 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11760 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11761 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11762 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11763 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011764
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011765prefer-client-ciphers
11766 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11767 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11768 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011769 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11770 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11771 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011772
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011773process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011774 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011775 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011776 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011777 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11778 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11779 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11780 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011781 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011782 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11783 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11784 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11785 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11786 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011787
11788 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11789
11790 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11791 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11792 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11793 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11794 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11795 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11796 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11797 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011798
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011799proto <name>
11800 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11801 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11802 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11803 in haproxy -vv.
11804 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11805 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011806 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011807 h2" on the bind line.
11808
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011809ssl
11810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011811 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011812 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11813 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011814 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11815 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011816
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011817ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11818 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11819 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11820 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11821
11822ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11823 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11824 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11825 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11826
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011827strict-sni
11828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11829 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11830 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11831 See the "crt" option for more information.
11832
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011833tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011834 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011835 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11836 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011837 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011838 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11839 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11840 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11841 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11842 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11843 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11844 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11845
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011846tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011847 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011848 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11849 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11850 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11851 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11852 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11853 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11854 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011855 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11856 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11857 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011858
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011859tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11860 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011861 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11862 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11863 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11864 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11865 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11866 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11867 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11868 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11869 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11870 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011871 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11872 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11873
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011874transparent
11875 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11876 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11877 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11878 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11879 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11880 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11881 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11882 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11883 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11884 so check for support with your vendor.
11885
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011886v4v6
11887 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11888 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11889 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11890 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011891 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011892
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011893v6only
11894 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11895 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11896 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011897 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11898 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011900uid <uid>
11901 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11902 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11903 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11904 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11905 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11906
11907user <user>
11908 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11909 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11910 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11911 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11912 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11913
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011914verify [none|optional|required]
11915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11916 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11917 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11918 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11919 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011920 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11921 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11922 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11923 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011924
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119255.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011926------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011928The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11929which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11930arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11931settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11932after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11933Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11934address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011936 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011937 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011938
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011939Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11940keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011942The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011943
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011944addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011945 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011946 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11947 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11948 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11949 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11950 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011951
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011952agent-check
11953 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011954 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011955 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11956 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11957 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011958
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011959 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011960 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011961 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11962 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11963 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011964
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011965 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11966 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11967 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11968 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11969 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011970
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011971 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011972 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011973
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011974 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11975 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11976 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011977
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011978 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11979 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11980 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011981
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011982 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11983 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11984 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11985 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11986 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011987 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011988 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011989
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011990 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11991 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011992
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011993 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11994 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11995 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11996 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11997 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11998 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11999 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12000 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12001 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012002
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012003 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12004 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012005 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12006 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12007 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012008 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012009
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012010 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012011 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012012
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012013agent-send <string>
12014 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12015 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12016 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12017 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12018 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12019
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012020agent-inter <delay>
12021 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12022 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12023
12024 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12025 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12026 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12027 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12028 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12029 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12030 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12031 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12032 of backends use the same servers.
12033
12034 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12035
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012036agent-addr <addr>
12037 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12038
12039 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12040 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12041 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12042 hostname, it will be resolved.
12043
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012044agent-port <port>
12045 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12046
12047 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12048
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012049allow-0rtt
12050 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012051 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12052 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012053
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012054alpn <protocols>
12055 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12056 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12057 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012058 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012059 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12060 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12061 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12062 now obsolete NPN extension.
12063 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12064 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12065
12066 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012068backup
12069 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12070 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12071 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12072 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012073 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12074 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012075
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012076ca-file <cafile>
12077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12078 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12079 server's certificate.
12080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012081check
12082 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012083 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12084 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12085 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12086 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12087 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12088 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12089 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012090 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12091 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012092 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12093 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012094
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012095check-send-proxy
12096 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12097 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12098 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12099 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12100 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12101 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12102 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12103
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012104check-alpn <protocols>
12105 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12106 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12107 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12108
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012109check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012110 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012111 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12112 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012113
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012114check-ssl
12115 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12116 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12117 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12118 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012119 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012120 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12121 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012122 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012123 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12124 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012125
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012126check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012127 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012128 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12129 for normal traffic.
12130
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012131ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12133 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12134 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012135 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12136 information and recommendations see e.g.
12137 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12138 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12139 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012140
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012141ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12143 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12144 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12145 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012146 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12147 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12148 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012150cookie <value>
12151 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12152 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12153 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12154 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12155 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12156 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12157 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12158
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012159crl-file <crlfile>
12160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12161 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12162 to verify server's certificate.
12163
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012164crt <cert>
12165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12166 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12167 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12168 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12169 certificate request.
12170
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012171disabled
12172 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12173 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12174 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12175 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12176 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012177 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012178
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012179enabled
12180 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12181 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12182 default value.
12183 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12184 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012186error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012187 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12188 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12189 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012191 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012193fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012194 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12195 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12196 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12197
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012198force-sslv3
12199 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12200 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012201 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012202 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012203
12204force-tlsv10
12205 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012206 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012207 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012208
12209force-tlsv11
12210 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012211 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012212 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012213
12214force-tlsv12
12215 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012216 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012217 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012218
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012219force-tlsv13
12220 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12221 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012222 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012224id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012225 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12226 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12227 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012228
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012229init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12230 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12231 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012232 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012233 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12234 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12235 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12236 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12237 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12238 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12239 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12240 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12241 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012242 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012243 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12244 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12245 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12246 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12247 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12248 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012249 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012250
12251 Example:
12252 defaults
12253 # never fail on address resolution
12254 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012256inter <delay>
12257fastinter <delay>
12258downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012259 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12260 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12261 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12262 between checks depending on the server state :
12263
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012264 Server state | Interval used
12265 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12266 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12267 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12268 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12269 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12270 or yet unchecked. |
12271 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12272 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12273 | "inter" otherwise.
12274 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012276 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12277 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12278 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12279 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012280 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12281 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12282 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12283 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12284 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012286maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012287 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12288 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012289 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12290 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012291 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12292 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12293 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12294 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12295
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012296 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12297 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12298 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12299 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12300 than 50 concurrent requests.
12301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012302maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012303 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12304 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12305 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12306 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12307 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12308 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12309 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12310
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012311max-reuse <count>
12312 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12313 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12314 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12315 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12316 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12317 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12318 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12319 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012321minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012322 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12323 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12324 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12325 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12326 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12327 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012328 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012329 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012330
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012331namespace <name>
12332 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12333 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12334 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12335 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12336
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012337no-agent-check
12338 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12339 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12340 default value.
12341 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12342 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12343
12344no-backup
12345 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12346 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12347 default value.
12348 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12349 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12350
12351no-check
12352 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12353 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12354 default value.
12355 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12356 "default-server" "check" setting.
12357
12358no-check-ssl
12359 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12360 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12361 default value.
12362 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12363 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12364
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012365no-send-proxy
12366 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12367 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12368 default value.
12369 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12370 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12371
12372no-send-proxy-v2
12373 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12374 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12375 default value.
12376 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12377 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12378
12379no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12380 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12381 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12382 default value.
12383 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12384 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12385
12386no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12387 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12388 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12389 default value.
12390 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12391 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12392
12393no-ssl
12394 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12395 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12396 default value.
12397 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12398 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12399
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012400no-ssl-reuse
12401 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12402 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12403 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12404 and for paranoid users.
12405
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012406no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012407 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12408 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012409 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012410
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012411 Supported in default-server: No
12412
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012413no-tls-tickets
12414 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12415 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12416 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012417 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12418 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012419 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12420 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12421 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012422 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012423
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012424no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012425 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012426 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12427 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012428 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12429 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012430 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012431
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012432 Supported in default-server: No
12433
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012434no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012435 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012436 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12437 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012438 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12439 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012440 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012441
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012442 Supported in default-server: No
12443
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012444no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012445 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012446 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12447 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012448 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12449 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012450 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012451
12452 Supported in default-server: No
12453
12454no-tlsv13
12455 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12456 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12457 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12458 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12459 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012460 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012461
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012462 Supported in default-server: No
12463
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012464no-verifyhost
12465 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12466 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12467 default value.
12468 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12469 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012470
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012471no-tfo
12472 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12473 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12474 default value.
12475 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12476 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12477
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012478non-stick
12479 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12480 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12481 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12482
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012483npn <protocols>
12484 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12485 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12486 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012487 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012488 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12489 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12490 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012492observe <mode>
12493 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12494 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12495 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12496 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12497 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12498 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012499 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012500
12501 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012503on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012504 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12505 Currently, four modes are available:
12506 - fastinter: force fastinter
12507 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12508 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12509 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12510 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12511
12512 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12513
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012514on-marked-down <action>
12515 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12516 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012517 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12518 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12519 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12520 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12521 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12522 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12523 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12524 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012525
12526 Actions are disabled by default
12527
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012528on-marked-up <action>
12529 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12530 Currently one action is available:
12531 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12532 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12533 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12534 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012535 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12536 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012537 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12538 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12539
12540 Actions are disabled by default
12541
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012542pool-max-conn <max>
12543 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12544 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12545 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12546 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12547 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12548 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12549
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012550pool-purge-delay <delay>
12551 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012552 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012553 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012555port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012556 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12557 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12558 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12559 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12560 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12561 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12562
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012563proto <name>
12564
12565 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12566 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12567 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12568 reported in haproxy -vv.
12569 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12570 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012572redir <prefix>
12573 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12574 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12575 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12576 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12577 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12578 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12579 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12580 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012581 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012582 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012583 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12584 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12585 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12586 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12587
12588 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012590rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012591 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12592 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12593 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12594
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012595resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12596 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12597 server.
12598
12599 Available options:
12600
12601 * allow-dup-ip
12602 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12603 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12604 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12605 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12606 For such case, simply enable this option.
12607 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12608
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012609 * ignore-weight
12610 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12611 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12612 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12613
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012614 * prevent-dup-ip
12615 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12616 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12617 same fqdn.
12618 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12619
12620 Example:
12621 backend b_myapp
12622 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12623 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12624 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12625
12626 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12627 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12628 it
12629 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12630 different address
12631
12632 Default value: not set
12633
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012634resolve-prefer <family>
12635 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12636 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12637 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12638 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12639
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012640 Default value: ipv6
12641
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012642 Example:
12643
12644 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012645
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012646resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012647 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012648 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012649 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012650 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12651 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012652 configured network, another address is selected.
12653
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012654 Example:
12655
12656 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012657
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012658resolvers <id>
12659 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12660 hostname.
12661
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012662 Example:
12663
12664 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012665
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012666 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012667
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012668send-proxy
12669 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12670 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12671 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12672 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012673 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12674 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12675 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12676 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12677 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12678 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12679 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12680 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12681 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12682 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012683 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12684 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012685
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012686send-proxy-v2
12687 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12688 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12689 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12690 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012691 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12692 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12693 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12694 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012695
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012696proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010012697 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
12698 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
12699
12700 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
12701 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
12702 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
12703 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
12704 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
12705 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
12706 connection is supported).
12707 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
12708 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
12709 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
12710 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
12711 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
12712 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
12713 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012714
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012715send-proxy-v2-ssl
12716 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12717 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12718 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12719 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12720 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12721 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12722 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012723 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12724 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012725
12726send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12727 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12728 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12729 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12730 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12731 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12732 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12733 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12734 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012735 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12736 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012738slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012739 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12740 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12741 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12742 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12743 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12744 parameters :
12745
12746 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12747 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12748
12749 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12750 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12751 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12752 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12753
12754 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12755 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12756 seen as failed.
12757
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012758sni <expression>
12759 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12760 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12761 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12762 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012763 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12764 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012765 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012766 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12767 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012768
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012769source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012770source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012771source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012772 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12773 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12774 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12775 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12776
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012777 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12778 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12779 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12780 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12781 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12782 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12783 server.
12784
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012785 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12786 specifying the source address without port(s).
12787
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012788ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012789 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12790 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12791 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12792 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12793 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12794 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012795 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12796 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012797
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012798ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12799 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12800 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12801 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12802
12803ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12804 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12805 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12806 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12807
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012808ssl-reuse
12809 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12810 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12811 default value.
12812 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12813 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12814
12815stick
12816 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12817 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12818 default value.
12819 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12820 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012821
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012822socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012823 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012824 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12825 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12826
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012827tcp-ut <delay>
12828 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12829 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12830 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012831 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012832 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12833 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12834 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12835 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12836 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12837 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12838 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12839 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12840 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12841
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012842tfo
12843 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12844 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12845 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12846 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12847 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012848 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012850track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012851 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12852 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12853 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12854 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012855 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12856
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012857tls-tickets
12858 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12859 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12860 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012861 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12862 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12863 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012864 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012865 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012866
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012867verify [none|required]
12868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012869 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012870 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12871 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012872 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012873 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12874 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12875 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12876 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12877 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12878 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12879 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12880 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012881
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012882verifyhost <hostname>
12883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012884 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12885 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12886 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12887 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12888 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12889 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12890 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12891 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012893weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012894 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12895 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12896 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012897 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12898 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12899 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12900 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12901 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12902 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012903
12904
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129055.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12906-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012907
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012908HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12909using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12910configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012911This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12912can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12913workload.
12914This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12915resolution at run time.
12916Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12917carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12918
12919
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129205.3.1. Global overview
12921----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012922
12923As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12924different steps of the process life:
12925
12926 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12927 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12928 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12929
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012930 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12931 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012932
12933A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12934 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12935 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12936 resolution to know this new IP.
12937
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012938When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012939HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012940SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12941from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12942will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12943will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012944
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012945A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012946 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012947 first valid response.
12948
12949 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12950 servers return an error.
12951
12952
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129535.3.2. The resolvers section
12954----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012955
12956This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012957HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12958contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012959
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012960When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12961uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12962is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12963answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12964
12965When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012966used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012967
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012968 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12969 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12970 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012971
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012972 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12973 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012974
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012975 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12976 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12977 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012978
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012979For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12980following scenarios are possible:
12981
12982 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12983 ignored
12984
12985 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12986 applied
12987
12988 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12989 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12990
12991 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12992 retries the query with a new type
12993
12994 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12995 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012996
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012997As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12998a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012999<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013000
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013001
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013002resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013003 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013004
13005A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13006
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013007accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013008 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013009 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013010 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13011 by RFC 6891)
13012
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013013 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13014
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013015nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13016 DNS server description:
13017 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13018 <ip> : IP address of the server
13019 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13020
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013021parse-resolv-conf
13022 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13023 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13024 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13025
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013026hold <status> <period>
13027 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13028 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013029 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013030 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013031 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13032 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13033 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13034
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013035 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013036
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013037resolve_retries <nb>
13038 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13039 giving up.
13040 Default value: 3
13041
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013042 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13043 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13044 type.
13045
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013046timeout <event> <time>
13047 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13048 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13049 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013050 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13051 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013052 Default value: 1s
13053 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013054 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013055 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013056 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13057 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13058
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013059 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013060
13061 resolvers mydns
13062 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13063 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013064 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013065 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013066 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013067 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013068 hold other 30s
13069 hold refused 30s
13070 hold nx 30s
13071 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013072 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013073 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013074
13075
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200130766. Cache
13077---------
13078
13079HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13080(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13081RAM.
13082
13083The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13084this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13085
13086If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13087independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13088when we try to allocate a new one.
13089
13090The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13091
13092It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13093"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13094for more details.
13095
13096When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13097replaced by "<CACHE>".
13098
13099
131006.1. Limitation
13101----------------
13102
13103The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13104
13105- If the response is not a 200
13106- If the response contains a Vary header
13107- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13108- If the response is not cacheable
13109
13110- If the request is not a GET
13111- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13112- If the request contains an Authorization header
13113
13114
131156.2. Setup
13116-----------
13117
13118To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13119the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13120
13121
131226.2.1. Cache section
13123---------------------
13124
13125cache <name>
13126 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13127 size of cache is mandatory.
13128
13129total-max-size <megabytes>
13130 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13131 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13132
13133max-object-size <bytes>
13134 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13135 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13136 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13137
13138max-age <seconds>
13139 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13140 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13141 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13142 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13143 default.
13144
13145
131466.2.2. Proxy section
13147---------------------
13148
13149http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13150 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13151 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13152 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13153 after this one.
13154
13155http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13156 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13157 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13158 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13159 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13160
13161
13162Example:
13163
13164 backend bck1
13165 mode http
13166
13167 http-request cache-use foobar
13168 http-response cache-store foobar
13169 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13170
13171 cache foobar
13172 total-max-size 4
13173 max-age 240
13174
13175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13177----------------------------------
13178
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013179HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013180client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13181The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13182these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13183but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13184data called patterns.
13185
13186
131877.1. ACL basics
13188---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013189
13190The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13191content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13192from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13193simple :
13194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013195 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013196 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013197 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13198 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13201adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013202
13203In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013205 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013206
13207This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13208Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13209and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013210an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13211conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13212as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13213are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013214
13215ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13216'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13217which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13218
13219There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13220performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013222The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13223specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13224this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013225methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13226ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013227
13228Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13229 - boolean
13230 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13231 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13232 - string
13233 - data block
13234
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013235Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13236converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13237would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13238The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13239which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13240
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013241Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13242keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13243fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13244which are summarized in the table below :
13245
13246 +---------------------+-----------------+
13247 | Sample or converter | Default |
13248 | output type | matching method |
13249 +---------------------+-----------------+
13250 | boolean | bool |
13251 +---------------------+-----------------+
13252 | integer | int |
13253 +---------------------+-----------------+
13254 | ip | ip |
13255 +---------------------+-----------------+
13256 | string | str |
13257 +---------------------+-----------------+
13258 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13259 +---------------------+-----------------+
13260
13261Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13262matching method, see below.
13263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013264The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13265 - boolean
13266 - integer or integer range
13267 - IP address / network
13268 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13269 - regular expression
13270 - hex block
13271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013272The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13273
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013274 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13275 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013277 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013278 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013279 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013280 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013282The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13283read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13284if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13285lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13286will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13287beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13288a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13289lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13290exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13291
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013292The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13293parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13294ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13295a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13296check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13297
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013298The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13299socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13300file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13303loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13304
13305 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13306
13307In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13308the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13309case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13310as well.
13311
13312The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13313sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13314do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13315methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13316is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013317obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013318followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13319default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13320that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13321string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13322
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013323The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13324By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13325string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13326resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13327server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013328waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013329flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13330function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013332There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13333sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13334be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013335
13336 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13337 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13339 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13340 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13341 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013342
13343 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13344 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013345 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013346
13347 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013348 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013349
13350 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013353 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013354 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13355
13356 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13357 binary or string samples.
13358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013359 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13360 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13363 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13364 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013366 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13367 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013369 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13370 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013372 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13373 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13376 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013377 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013379 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13380 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13381 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013382
13383For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13384request, it is possible to do :
13385
13386 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13387
13388In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13389buffer, one would use the following acl :
13390
13391 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13392
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013393On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13394possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13395
13396 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13399criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13400method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13401to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13402criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13403the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013406the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13407For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013409 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13410 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13411 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13412 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013413
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013414
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013415The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13416types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13417combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13418brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13419default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013421 +-------------------------------------------------+
13422 | Input sample type |
13423 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013424 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013425 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13426 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13427 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013428 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013429 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013430 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013432 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013433 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013434 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013436 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013437 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013438 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013440 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013442 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013444 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013446 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013448 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013449 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13450 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13451 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013452
13453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134547.1.1. Matching booleans
13455------------------------
13456
13457In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13458Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13459When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13460that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13461
13462Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13463return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13464"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134677.1.2. Matching integers
13468------------------------
13469
13470Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13471enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13472to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13473
13474Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13475matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13476lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013477
13478For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13479unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13480representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13481
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013482As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13483two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13484instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13485ranges and operators.
13486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013487For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013488operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13489Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13490of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013492Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013493
13494 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13495 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13496 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13497 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13498 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013500For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013501
13502 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13503
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013504This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13505
13506 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13507
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135097.1.3. Matching strings
13510-----------------------
13511
13512String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13513different forms :
13514
13515 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013516 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013517
13518 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013519 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013520
13521 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13522 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13523
13524 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13525 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13526
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013527 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013528 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13529 matches.
13530
13531 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13532 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13533 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013534
13535String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13536exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13537characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13538string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13539to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013540before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013541
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013542Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13543(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13544Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13545
13546Example:
13547 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13548 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13549
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135517.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13552---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013553
13554Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13555they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13556possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13557passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13558the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013559the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13560match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013561
13562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135637.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13564-------------------------------------
13565
13566It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13567not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13568a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13569to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13570digits may be used upper or lower case.
13571
13572Example :
13573 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13574 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13575
13576
135777.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13578---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013579
13580IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13581netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13582within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013583host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013584difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13585at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13586does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13587parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013588
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013589The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13590abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13591
13592 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13593 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13594 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13595 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13596 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13597 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13598 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13599 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13600
13601Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13602192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13603
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013604IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13605Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13606trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13607IPv6 patterns.
13608
13609HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13610following situations :
13611 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13612 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13613 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13614 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13615 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13616 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13617 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13618 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13619 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13620 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013622
136237.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13624----------------------------------
13625
13626Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13627combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13628
13629 - AND (implicit)
13630 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13631 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013633A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013637Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13638indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013640For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13641"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13642requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13643is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13644
13645 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013646 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13647 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13648 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013649
13650To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13651and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13652
13653 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13654 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13655 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13656 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13657
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013658 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013659 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13660 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13661 use_backend www if host_www
13662
13663It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13664expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13665be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13666the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13667
13668 The following rule :
13669
13670 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013671 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013672
13673 Can also be written that way :
13674
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013675 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013676
13677It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13678to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13679simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13680sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13681good use is the following :
13682
13683 With named ACLs :
13684
13685 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13686 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13687 monitor fail if site_dead
13688
13689 With anonymous ACLs :
13690
13691 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13692
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013693See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13694keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013695
13696
136977.3. Fetching samples
13698---------------------
13699
13700Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13701against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13702sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13703ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13704of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13705available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13706
13707This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13708Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13709compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13710deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13711
13712The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13713matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13714method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13715indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13716
13717As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13718when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13719mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13720the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13721ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13722
13723Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13724multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13725when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013726incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13727are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013728is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13729all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13730
13731Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13732 - name
13733 - name(arg1)
13734 - name(arg1,arg2)
13735
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013736
137377.3.1. Converters
13738-----------------
13739
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013740Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13741of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13742is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13743was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013744has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013745unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13746
13747These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13748sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13749the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013751
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013752A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13753support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13754supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13755(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13756bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013758The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013759
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001376051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13761 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13762 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13763 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13764 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13765 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13766
13767 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013768 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13769 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013770 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13771 frontend http-in
13772 bind *:8081
13773 default_backend servers
13774 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13775 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13776
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013777add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013778 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013779 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013780 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13781 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013782 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013783 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13784 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13785 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13786 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013787 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013788 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013789
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013790aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13791 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13792 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13793 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13794 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13795 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13796 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13797
13798 Example:
13799 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13800 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13801
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013802and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013803 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013804 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013805 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13806 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013807 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013808 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13809 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13810 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13811 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013812 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013813 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013814
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013815b64dec
13816 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13817 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13818
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013819base64
13820 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013821 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013822 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13823
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013824bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013825 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013826 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013827 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013828 presence of a flag).
13829
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013830bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13831 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13832 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013833 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013834
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013835concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13836 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13837 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13838 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13839 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13840 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13841 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13842 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13843 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13844 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13845 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013846 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
13847 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
13848 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
13849 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013850
13851 Example:
13852 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13853 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13854 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013855 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013856 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13857
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013858cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013859 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13860 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013861
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013862crc32([<avalanche>])
13863 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13864 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13865 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13866 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13867 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13868 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13869 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13870 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13871 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13872 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013873 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13874
13875crc32c([<avalanche>])
13876 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13877 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13878 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13879 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13880 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13881 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13882 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13883 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013884
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013885da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013886 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13887 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13888 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13889 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013890 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013891 configuration language.
13892
13893 Example:
13894 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013895 bind *:8881
13896 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013897 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013898
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013899debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13900 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13901 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13902 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13903 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13904 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13905 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13906 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13907 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13908 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13909 printable sample types.
13910
13911 Example:
13912 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013913
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013914div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013915 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13916 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013917 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013918 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13919 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013920 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013921 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13922 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13923 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13924 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013925 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013926 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013927
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013928djb2([<avalanche>])
13929 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13930 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13931 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13932 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13933 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13934 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13935 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013936 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13937 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013938
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013939even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013940 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013941 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13942
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013943field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13944 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13945 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13946 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13947 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13948 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13949 fields.
13950
13951 Example :
13952 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13953 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13954 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13955 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13956 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013957
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013958hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013959 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013960 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013961 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013962 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013963
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013964hex2i
13965 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013966 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013967
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013968http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013969 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13970 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013971 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13972 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13973 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13974 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13975 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13976 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13977 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13978 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013980in_table(<table>)
13981 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13982 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13983 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013984 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013985 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13986
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013987ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13988 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013989 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013990 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13991 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13992 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13993 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13994 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013995
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013996json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013997 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013998 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013999 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014000 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14001 of errors:
14002 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14003 bytes, ...)
14004 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14005 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14006
14007 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14008 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14009 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14010 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14011 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14012 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014013 - "ascii" : never fails;
14014 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14015 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014016 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014017 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014018 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14019 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14020
14021 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014022 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014023
14024 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014025 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014026 capture request header user-agent len 150
14027 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014028
14029 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14030 GET / HTTP/1.0
14031 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14032
14033 Output log:
14034 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14035
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014036language(<value>[,<default>])
14037 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14038 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14039 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14040 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14041 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14042 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14043 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14044 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14045 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014046 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014047 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14048 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014049
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014050 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014052 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14053 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014054
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014055 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14056 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14057 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14058 use_backend spanish if es
14059 use_backend french if fr
14060 use_backend english if en
14061 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014062
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014063length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014064 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14065 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14066 type. The result is of type integer.
14067
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014068lower
14069 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14070 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14071 type. The result is of type string.
14072
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014073ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14074 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14075 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14076 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14077 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14078 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14079 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14080
14081 Example :
14082
14083 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014084 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014085 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14086
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014087map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14088map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14089map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14090 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14091 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14092 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14093 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14094 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14095 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14096 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14097 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014098
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014099 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14100 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14101 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014102
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014103 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014104 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014105
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014106 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14107 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14108 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14109 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014110 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14111 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014112 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14113 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14114 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14115 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14116 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14117 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14118 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14119 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014120 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14121 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14122 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014123 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14124 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14125 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14126 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14127 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014128
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014129 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14130 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14131 the corresponding match text.
14132
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014133 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14134 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14135 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14136 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14137 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014138
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014139 Example :
14140
14141 # this is a comment and is ignored
14142 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14143 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14144 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14145 | | | `---------- value
14146 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14147 | `---------------------------- key
14148 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14149
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014150mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014151 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14152 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014153 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014154 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014155 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014156 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14157 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14158 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14159 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014160 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014161 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014162
14163mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014164 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014165 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14166 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014167 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014168 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014169 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014170 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14171 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14172 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14173 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014174 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014175 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014176
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014177nbsrv
14178 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14179 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14180 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14181 map lookup.
14182
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014183neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014184 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14185 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14186 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14187 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014188
14189not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014190 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014191 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014192 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014193 absence of a flag).
14194
14195odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014196 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014197 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14198
14199or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014200 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014201 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014202 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14203 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014204 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014205 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14206 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14207 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14208 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014209 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014210 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014211
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014212protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14213 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14214 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14215 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14216 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14217 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14218 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14219 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14220 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14221 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14222 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14223 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14224
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014225regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014226 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14227 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14228 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14229 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14230 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14231 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14232 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14233 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14234 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014235 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14236 of characters with other ones.
14237
14238 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14239 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14240 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14241 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14242 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14243 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014244
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014245 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014246
14247 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14248 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14249 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014250 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014251
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014252 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14253 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14254
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014255 # capture groups and backreferences
14256 # both lines do the same.
14257 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14258 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14259
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014260capture-req(<id>)
14261 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14262 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14263
14264 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014265 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14266 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014267
14268capture-res(<id>)
14269 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14270 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14271
14272 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014273 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14274 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014275
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014276sdbm([<avalanche>])
14277 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14278 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14279 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14280 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14281 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14282 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14283 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014284 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14285 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014286
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014287set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014288 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14289 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14290 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014291 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014292 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14293 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014294 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014295 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14296 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014297 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014298 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014299
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014300sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014301 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014302 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14303
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014304sha2([<bits>])
14305 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14306 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14307
14308 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14309 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14310
14311 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14312 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14313
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014314srv_queue
14315 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14316 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14317 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14318 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14319 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14320
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014321strcmp(<var>)
14322 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14323 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14324 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14325 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14326 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14327 shorter).
14328
14329 Example :
14330
14331 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14332 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14333 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14334
14335
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014336sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014337 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14338 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014339 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014340 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14341 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014342 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014343 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14344 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014345 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014346 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14347 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014348 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014349 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014350
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014351table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14352 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14353 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14354 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14355 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14356 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14357 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14358
14359
14360table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14361 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14362 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14363 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14364 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14365 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14366 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14367
14368table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14369 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14370 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014371 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014372 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14373 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14374
14375table_conn_cur(<table>)
14376 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14377 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14378 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14379 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14380 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14381
14382table_conn_rate(<table>)
14383 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14384 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14385 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14386 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14387 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14388
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014389table_gpt0(<table>)
14390 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14391 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14392 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14393 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14394 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14395
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014396table_gpc0(<table>)
14397 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14398 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14399 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14400 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14401 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14402
14403table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14404 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14405 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14406 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14407 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14408 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14409 sample fetch keyword.
14410
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014411table_gpc1(<table>)
14412 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14413 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14414 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14415 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14416 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14417
14418table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14419 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14420 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14421 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14422 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14423 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14424 sample fetch keyword.
14425
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014426table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14427 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14428 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014429 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014430 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14431 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14432
14433table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14434 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14435 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14436 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14437 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14438 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14439 keyword.
14440
14441table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14442 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14443 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014444 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014445 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14446 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14447
14448table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14449 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14450 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14451 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14452 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14453 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14454 keyword.
14455
14456table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14457 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14458 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014459 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014460 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14461 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14462 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14463 keyword.
14464
14465table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014468 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014469 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14470 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14471 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14472 keyword.
14473
14474table_server_id(<table>)
14475 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14476 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14477 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14478 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14479 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14480 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14481
14482table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014486 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14487 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14488 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14489 keyword.
14490
14491table_sess_rate(<table>)
14492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14494 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14495 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14496 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14497 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14498 keyword.
14499
14500table_trackers(<table>)
14501 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14502 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14503 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14504 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14505 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14506 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14507 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14508 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14509 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14510 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14511
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014512upper
14513 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14514 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14515 type. The result is of type string.
14516
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014517url_dec
14518 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14519 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14520
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014521ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014522 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014523 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14524 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14525 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014526 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14527 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14528 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14529 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014530 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014531 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14532 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014533
14534 Example:
14535 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14536 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14537
14538 message Point {
14539 int32 latitude = 1;
14540 int32 longitude = 2;
14541 }
14542
14543 message PPoint {
14544 Point point = 59;
14545 }
14546
14547 message Rectangle {
14548 // One corner of the rectangle.
14549 PPoint lo = 48;
14550 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14551 PPoint hi = 49;
14552 }
14553
14554 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14555 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14556 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14557
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014558 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14559 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014560 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014561 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14562
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014563 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014564
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014565 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014566
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014567 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014568 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14569 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14570
14571 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14572 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14573 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14574
14575 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14576 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14577 interpret the previous binary sample.
14578
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014579
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014580unset-var(<var name>)
14581 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14582 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14583 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14584 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14585 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14586 response),
14587 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14588 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14589 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14590 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14591
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014592utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14593 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14594 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14595 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14596 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14597 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14598 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14599
14600 Example :
14601
14602 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014603 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014604 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14605
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014606word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14607 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14608 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14609 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014610 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014611 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14612 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14613
14614 Example :
14615 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14616 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14617 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14618 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14619 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014620 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014621
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014622wt6([<avalanche>])
14623 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14624 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14625 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14626 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14627 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14628 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14629 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014630 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14631 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014632
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014633xor(<value>)
14634 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014635 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014636 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014637 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014638 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014639 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14640 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014641 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014642 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014645 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014646
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014647xxh32([<seed>])
14648 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14649 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14650 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14651 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14652 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14653 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14654 as cryptographically secure.
14655
14656xxh64([<seed>])
14657 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14658 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14659 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14660 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14661 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14662 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14663 as cryptographically secure.
14664
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014665
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146667.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014667--------------------------------------------
14668
14669A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14670not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14671"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14672The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14673
14674always_false : boolean
14675 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14676 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14677
14678always_true : boolean
14679 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14680 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14681
14682avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014683 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014684 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14685 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14686 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14687 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14688 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14689 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14690 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14691 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14692 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14693 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14694 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14695 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14696 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014698be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014699 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14700 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14701 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14702 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014703 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14704
14705be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14706 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14707 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14708 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14709 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14710 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014711 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14712 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014713
14714 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14715 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14716 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014718be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14719 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14720 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14721 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014722 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014723 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14724 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014725
14726 Example :
14727 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14728 backend dynamic
14729 mode http
14730 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14731 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014732
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014733bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014734 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14735 of the string.
14736
14737bool(<bool>) : bool
14738 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14739 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014743 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014744 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14745 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014746
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014747 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014748 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014749 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14750
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014751 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14752 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014753
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014754 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014755 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014756 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014757 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014758 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014760 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014761
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014762 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14763 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014765 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014766
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014767cpu_calls : integer
14768 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14769 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14770 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14771 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14772 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14773 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14774
14775cpu_ns_avg : integer
14776 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14777 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14778 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14779 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14780 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14781 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14782 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14783 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14784 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14785 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14786 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14787
14788cpu_ns_tot : integer
14789 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14790 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14791 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14792 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14793 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14794 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14795 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14796 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14797 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14798 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14799 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14800 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14801 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14802
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014803date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014804 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014805
14806 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14807 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14808 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014809 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14810
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014811 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14812 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14813 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14814 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14815 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14816
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014817 Example :
14818
14819 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14820 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014821
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014822 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14823 # millisecond granularity
14824 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14825
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014826date_us : integer
14827 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14828 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14829 from the same timeval structure.
14830
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014831distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14832 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14833 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14834 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14835 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14836 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14837 list of supported tokens.
14838
14839distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14840 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14841 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14842 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14843 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14844 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14845 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14846 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14847 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14848 supported tokens.
14849
14850 Example :
14851 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14852 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14853 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14854 # send large files to the big farm
14855 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14856
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014857env(<name>) : string
14858 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14859 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14860 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14861 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14862 certain way.
14863
14864 Examples :
14865 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14866 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14867
14868 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14869 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14872 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014873 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14874 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14876 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014877 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14879 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014880
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014881fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14882 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14883 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14884 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14887 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14888 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14889 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14890 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14891 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14892 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14893 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14894 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014895
14896 Example :
14897 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14898 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14899 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14900 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14901 frontend mail
14902 bind :25
14903 mode tcp
14904 maxconn 100
14905 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14906 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14907 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14908 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014909
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014910hostname : string
14911 Returns the system hostname.
14912
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014913int(<integer>) : signed integer
14914 Returns a signed integer.
14915
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014916ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14917 Returns an ipv4.
14918
14919ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14920 Returns an ipv6.
14921
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014922lat_ns_avg : integer
14923 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14924 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14925 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14926 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14927 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14928 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14929 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14930 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14931 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14932 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14933 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14934 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14935 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14936 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14937
14938lat_ns_tot : integer
14939 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14940 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14941 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14942 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14943 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14944 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14945 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14946 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14947 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14948 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14949 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14950 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14951 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14952 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14953 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14954 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14955 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14956 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14957 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14958
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014959meth(<method>) : method
14960 Returns a method.
14961
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014962nbproc : integer
14963 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14964 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14965 and debugging purposes.
14966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14968 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14969 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14970 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014971 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14972 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14973 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014974
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014975prio_class : integer
14976 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14977 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14978 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14979
14980prio_offset : integer
14981 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14982 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14983 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14984 set-priority-offset".
14985
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014986proc : integer
14987 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14988 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14989 debugging purposes.
14990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014992 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14993 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14994 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14996 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14997 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14998 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14999 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15000
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015001rand([<range>]) : integer
15002 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15003 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15004 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15005 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15006 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15007
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015008uuid([<version>]) : string
15009 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15010 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15011 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15014 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15015 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15016 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15017 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15018 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015019 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15020 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15021
15022srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15024 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15025 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15026 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15027 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15028 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15029 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15030
15031 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15032 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015033
15034srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15035 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15036 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15037 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015038 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015039 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15040 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15041 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15042
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015043srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15044 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15045 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15046 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15047 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15048 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15049 fetch methods.
15050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15052 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15053 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015054 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15056 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015057 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058 overloading servers).
15059
15060 Example :
15061 # Redirect to a separate back
15062 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15063 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15064 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15065
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015066stopping : boolean
15067 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15068 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15069 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15070
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015071str(<string>) : string
15072 Returns a string.
15073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15075 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15076 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15077
15078table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15079 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15080 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15081 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15082
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015083thread : integer
15084 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15085 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15086 and debugging purposes.
15087
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015088var(<var-name>) : undefined
15089 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015090 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15091 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015092 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015093 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15094 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015095 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015096 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15097 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015098 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015099 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015100
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151017.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102----------------------------------
15103
15104The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15105closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15106methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15107sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15108TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015109the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15110counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015111"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15112used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15113can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15114Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15115table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15116tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15117currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015119bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015120 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15121 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15122 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124be_id : integer
15125 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15126 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15127
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015128be_name : string
15129 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15130 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132dst : ip
15133 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15134 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15135 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15136 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015137 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15138 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15139 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15140 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15141 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15142 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143
15144dst_conn : integer
15145 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15146 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15147 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15148 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15149 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15150 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15151 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15152 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015153
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015154dst_is_local : boolean
15155 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15156 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15157 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15158 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015159 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015160 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15161 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15162 it only once per connection.
15163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164dst_port : integer
15165 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15166 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15167 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15168 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15169 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15170 an HTTP header.
15171
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015172fc_http_major : integer
15173 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15174 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15175 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15176
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015177fc_pp_authority : string
15178 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15179 if any.
15180
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015181fc_pp_unique_id : string
15182 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15183 if any.
15184
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015185fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15186 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15187 header.
15188
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015189fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15190 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15191 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15192 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15193 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15194 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15195 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15196
15197fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15198 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15199 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15200 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15201 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15202 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15203 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15204
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015205fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015206 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15207 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15208 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15209 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15210
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015211fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015212 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15213 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15214 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15215 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15216
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015217fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015218 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15219 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15220 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15221 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15222
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015223fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015224 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15225 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15226 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15227 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15228
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015229fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015230 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15231 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15232 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15233 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15234
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015235fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015236 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15237 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15238 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15239 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15240
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015241fe_defbe : string
15242 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15243 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245fe_id : integer
15246 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015247 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15249
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015250fe_name : string
15251 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15252 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15253 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15254
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015255sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015256sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15257sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15258sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015259 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15260 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15261 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15262
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015263sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015264sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15265sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15266sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015267 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15268 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15269 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15270
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015271sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015272sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15273sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15274sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015275 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15276 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015277 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15278 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15279 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015280
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015281 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015282 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15283 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015284 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15285 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15286 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015287 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15288 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15289
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015290sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15291sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15292sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15293sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15294 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15295 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15296 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15297 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15298 when a first ACL was verified.
15299
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015300sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015301sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15302sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15303sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015304 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015305 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15306
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015307sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015308sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15309sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15310sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015311 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15312 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15313 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15314
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015315sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015316sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15317sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15318sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015319 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15320 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15321 See also src_conn_rate.
15322
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015323sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015324sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15325sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15326sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015327 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015328 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015329
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015330sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15331sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15332sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15333sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15334 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15335 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15336
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015337sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15338sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15339sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15340sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15341 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15342 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15343
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015344sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015345sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15346sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15347sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015348 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15349 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15350 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015351 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15352 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15353 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015354
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015355sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15356sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15357sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15358sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15359 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15360 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15361 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15362 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15363 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15364 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15365
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015366sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015367sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15368sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15369sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015371 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15372 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15373
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015374sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015375sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15376sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15377sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015378 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15379 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15380 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15381 src_http_err_rate.
15382
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015383sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015384sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15385sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15386sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015387 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015388 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15389 src_http_req_cnt.
15390
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015391sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015392sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15393sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15394sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015395 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15396 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15397 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15398 src_http_req_rate.
15399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015400sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015401sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15402sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15403sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015404 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015405 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15406 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15407 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15408 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015409
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015410 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015411 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15412 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015413 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15414
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015415sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15416sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15417sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15418sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15419 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15420 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15421 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15422 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15423 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15424
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015425sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015426sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15427sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15428sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015429 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15430 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15431 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015432
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015433sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015434sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15435sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15436sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015437 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15438 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15439 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015440
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015441sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015442sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15443sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15444sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015445 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015446 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15447 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15448 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015449 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015450 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15451
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015452sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015453sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15454sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15455sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015456 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15457 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15458 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15459 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15460 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015461 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015462
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015463sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015464sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15465sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15466sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015467 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15468 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15469 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15470
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015471sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015472sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15473sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15474sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015475 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15476 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015477 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015478 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15479 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15481 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15482 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484so_id : integer
15485 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15486 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15487 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015488
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015489so_name : string
15490 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15491 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15492 strings instead of integers.
15493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015495 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15497 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15498 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015499 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15500 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15501 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015502 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15503 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15504 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15505 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15506 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15507 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15508 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015509
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015510 Example:
15511 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15512 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15515 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15516 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15517 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015518 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15521 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15522 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015523 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015524 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15527 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15528 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15529 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15530 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15531 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15532 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015533
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015534 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015535 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15536 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15537 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15538 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015539 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015540 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15541 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15542
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015543src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15544 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15545 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15546 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15547 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15548 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15549 was verified.
15550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015552 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015554 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015555 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015558 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15560 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015561 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15564 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15565 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15566 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015567 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015570 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015572 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015573 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015574
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015575src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15576 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15577 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15578 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15579 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15580
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015581src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15582 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15583 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15584 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15585 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015588 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015590 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15591 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015592 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15593 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15594 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015595
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015596src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15597 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15598 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15599 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15600 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15601 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15602 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15603 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015606 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015608 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015609 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15613 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15614 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15615 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15616 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015617 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015620 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15622 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015623 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15626 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15627 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15628 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015629 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015630 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015632src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15633 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15634 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15635 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015636 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15638 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015639
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015640 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015641 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015642 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015643 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015644
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015645src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15646 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15647 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15648 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15649 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15650 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15651 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15652
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015653src_is_local : boolean
15654 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15655 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15656 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15657 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015658 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015659 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15660 once per connection.
15661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015663 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15664 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15665 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15666 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15667 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015670 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15671 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15672 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15673 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15674 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015676src_port : integer
15677 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15678 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15679 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15680 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015683 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015684 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15685 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15686 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015687 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15690 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15691 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15692 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15693 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015694 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15697 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15698 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15699 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15700 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15701 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15702 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15703 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15704 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015705
15706 Example :
15707 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15708 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15709 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15710 listen ssh
15711 bind :22
15712 mode tcp
15713 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015714 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015716 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718srv_id : integer
15719 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15720 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15721 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015722
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015723srv_name : string
15724 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15725 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15726 debugging.
15727
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157287.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15732closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15733when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15734usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015735future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015736
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001573751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15738 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15739 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15740 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15741 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15742 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15743
15744 Example :
15745 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15746 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15747 # the request.
15748 frontend http-in
15749 bind *:8081
15750 default_backend servers
15751 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15752 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15753
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015754ssl_bc : boolean
15755 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15756 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15757 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15758
15759ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15760 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15761 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15762
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015763ssl_bc_alpn : string
15764 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15765 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015766 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015767 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15768 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15769 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15770 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15771 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15772 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15773
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015774ssl_bc_cipher : string
15775 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15776 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15777
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015778ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15779 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15780 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15781 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15782
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015783ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15784 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15785 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15786 session or a TLS ticket.
15787
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015788ssl_bc_npn : string
15789 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15790 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015791 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015792 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15793 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15794 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15795 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15796 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15797
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015798ssl_bc_protocol : string
15799 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15800 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15801
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015802ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015803 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015804 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15805 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015806
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015807ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15808 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15809 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15810 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15811
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015812ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15813 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15814 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15815 if session was reused or not.
15816
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015817ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15818 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15819 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15820 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15821 BoringSSL.
15822
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015823ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15824 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15825 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015827ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15828 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15829 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15830 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15831 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15832 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15835 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15836 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15837 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15838 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015839
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015840ssl_c_der : binary
15841 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15842 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15843 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015845ssl_c_err : integer
15846 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15847 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15848 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15849 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15850 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015851
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015852ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015853 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15854 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15855 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15856 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15857 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15858 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15859 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15860 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015861 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15862 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15863 LDAP v3.
15864 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15865 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867ssl_c_key_alg : string
15868 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15869 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15870 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872ssl_c_notafter : string
15873 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15874 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15875 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877ssl_c_notbefore : string
15878 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15879 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15880 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015881
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015882ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15884 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15885 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15886 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15887 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15888 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15889 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15890 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015891 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15892 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15893 LDAP v3.
15894 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15895 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897ssl_c_serial : binary
15898 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15899 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15900 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15903 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15904 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15905 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015906 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15907 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15908
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015909 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015910 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15913 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15914 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15915 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917ssl_c_used : boolean
15918 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15919 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921ssl_c_verify : integer
15922 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15923 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15924 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15925 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015927ssl_c_version : integer
15928 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15929 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015930
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015931ssl_f_der : binary
15932 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15933 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15934 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15935
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015936ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015937 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15938 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15939 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15940 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015941 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15943 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15944 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015945 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15946 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15947 LDAP v3.
15948 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15949 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951ssl_f_key_alg : string
15952 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15953 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15954 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956ssl_f_notafter : string
15957 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15958 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15959 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961ssl_f_notbefore : string
15962 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15963 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15964 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015965
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015966ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15968 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15969 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15970 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15971 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15972 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15973 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15974 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015975 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15976 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15977 LDAP v3.
15978 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15979 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981ssl_f_serial : binary
15982 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15983 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15984 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015985
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015986ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15987 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15988 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15989 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15992 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15993 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15994 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996ssl_f_version : integer
15997 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15998 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15999
16000ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016001 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16002 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16003 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 Example :
16006 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16007 listen http-https
16008 bind :80
16009 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16010 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16011
16012ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16013 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16014 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16015
16016ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016017 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16019 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16020 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16021 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16022 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16023 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16024 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16025 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027ssl_fc_cipher : string
16028 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16029 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016030
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016031ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16032 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16033 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016034 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016035
16036ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16037 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16038 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016039 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016040
16041ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16042 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16043 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16044 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016045 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016046 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016047
16048ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16049 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16050 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016051 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016052
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016053ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16054 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16055 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16056 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016059 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16060 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016061 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16062 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16063 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16064 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016065
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016066ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16067 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16068 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16069 wait until the handshake happened.
16070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16072 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016073 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16074 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016075 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016076 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016077
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016078ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016079 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016080 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16081 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016083ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016084 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16086 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16087 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16088 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16089 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16090 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16091 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093ssl_fc_protocol : string
16094 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16095 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016096
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016097ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016098 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016099 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16100 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016101
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016102ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16103 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16104 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16105 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16108 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16109 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16110 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16111 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016112
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016113ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16114 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16115 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16116 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16117 BoringSSL.
16118
16119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120ssl_fc_sni : string
16121 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16122 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16123 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16124 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16125 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16126
16127 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16128 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16129 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016130 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016131 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16135 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16138 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16139 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016140
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016141
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161427.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016143------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16146sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16147only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16148For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16149be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16150can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16151sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16152for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16153content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016156 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16158 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16161 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016162 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016164
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016165req.hdrs : string
16166 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16167 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16168 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16169 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16170
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016171req.hdrs_bin : binary
16172 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16173 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16174 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16175 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16176 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16177 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16178
16179 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16180
16181 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16182 str: <int:length><bytes>
16183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184req.len : integer
16185req_len : integer (deprecated)
16186 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16187 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16188 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16189 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16190 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16191 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16192 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16193 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16196 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016197 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16198 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16199 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16200 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202 ACL alternatives :
16203 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16206 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16207 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16208 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16209 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211 ACL alternatives :
16212 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216req.proto_http : boolean
16217req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16218 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16219 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16220 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16221 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16222 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16223 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16224 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226 Example:
16227 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16228 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16229 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016230 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16233rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16234 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16235 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16236 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16237 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16238 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16239 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16240 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016242 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16243 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16244 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16245 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16246 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16247 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 ACL derivatives :
16250 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252 Example :
16253 listen tse-farm
16254 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16255 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16256 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16257 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16258 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16259 persist rdp-cookie
16260 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16261 # This is only useful makes sense if
16262 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16263 stick-table type string size 204800
16264 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16265 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16266 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16269 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016271req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16272rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16273 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16274 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16275 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16276 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 ACL derivatives :
16279 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016280
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016281req.ssl_alpn : string
16282 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16283 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16284 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16285 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16286 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16287 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016288 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016289
16290 Examples :
16291 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16292 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16293 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016294 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016295 default_backend bk_default
16296
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016297req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16298 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16299 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016300 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16301 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16302 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16303 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16304 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16307req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16308 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16309 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16310 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16311 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16312 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16313 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16314 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316req.ssl_sni : string
16317req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16318 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16319 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16320 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16321 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16322 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16323 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16324 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16325 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16326 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16327 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16328 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16329 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331 ACL derivatives :
16332 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334 Examples :
16335 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16336 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16337 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16338 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16339 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016340
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016341req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16342 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16343 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16344 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16345 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16346 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16347 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16348 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16349 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16350 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352req.ssl_ver : integer
16353req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16354 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16355 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16356 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16357 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16358 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16359 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16360 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016361 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016362 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016364 ACL derivatives :
16365 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016366
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016367res.len : integer
16368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16369 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16370 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16371 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16372 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16373 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16374 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16375 content inspection.
16376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16378 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016379 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16380 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16381 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16382 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016384res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16385 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16386 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16387 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16388 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016391
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016392res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16393rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16394 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16395 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16396 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16397 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16398 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16399 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16400 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016402wait_end : boolean
16403 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16404 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016405 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16407 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016408 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016409 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16410 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016412 Examples :
16413 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16414 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16415 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016417 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16418 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16419 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16420 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16421 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16422 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16423 tcp-request content reject
16424
16425
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164267.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016427--------------------------------------
16428
16429It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16430This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16431data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16432its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16433HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16434content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16435to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16436more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16437response are indexed.
16438
16439base : string
16440 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16441 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16442 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16443 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16444 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16445 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16446 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16447 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16448
16449 ACL derivatives :
16450 base : exact string match
16451 base_beg : prefix match
16452 base_dir : subdir match
16453 base_dom : domain match
16454 base_end : suffix match
16455 base_len : length match
16456 base_reg : regex match
16457 base_sub : substring match
16458
16459base32 : integer
16460 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16461 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16462 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016463 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16464 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16465 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016466
16467base32+src : binary
16468 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16469 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16470 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16471 per-URL counters.
16472
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016473capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16474 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16475 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16476 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16477
16478capture.req.method : string
16479 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16480 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16481 because it's allocated.
16482
16483capture.req.uri : string
16484 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16485 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16486 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16487 allocated.
16488
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016489capture.req.ver : string
16490 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16491 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16492 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16493
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016494capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16495 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16496 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16497 The first entry is an index of 0.
16498 See also: "capture response header"
16499
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016500capture.res.ver : string
16501 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16502 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16503 persistent flag.
16504
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016505req.body : binary
16506 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16507 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16508 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16509 the first chunk is analyzed.
16510
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016511req.body_param([<name>) : string
16512 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16513 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16514 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16515 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16516 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16517 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16518 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16519 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16520 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16521 given.
16522
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016523req.body_len : integer
16524 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16525 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16526 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16527 "option http-buffer-request".
16528
16529req.body_size : integer
16530 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16531 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16532 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16533 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16534 "option http-buffer-request".
16535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536req.cook([<name>]) : string
16537cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16538 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16539 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16540 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16541 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16542 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16543 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16544 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16545 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16546
16547 ACL derivatives :
16548 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16549 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16550 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16551 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16552 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16553 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16554 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16555 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16558cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16559 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16560 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16563cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16564 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16565 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16566 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16567 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016569cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16570 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16571 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16572 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16573 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016574 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16576 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16577 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16578 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16581 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16582 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16583 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16584 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016585 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016587req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16588 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16589 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16590 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16591 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16592 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16593 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16594 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16595 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016597req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16598 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16599 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16600 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16601 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016603req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16604 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16605 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16606 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16607 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16608 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16609 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16610 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16611 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016612 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016613 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016614 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016616 ACL derivatives :
16617 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16618 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16619 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16620 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16621 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16622 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16623 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16624 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16625
16626req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16627hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16628 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16629 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16630 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16631 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16632 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16633 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16634 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16635 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16636 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16637
16638req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16639hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16640 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16641 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16642 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16643 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16644 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016645 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016646 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16647 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16648
16649req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16650hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16651 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16652 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16653 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16654 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16655 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16656 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16657 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16658
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016659
16660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16662 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16663 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16664 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16665 basic auth is supported.
16666
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016667http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16668 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16669 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16670 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16671 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16673 basic auth is supported.
16674
16675 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016676 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16677 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16678 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16679 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016680
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016681http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016682 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16683 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16684 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016685
16686http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016687 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16688 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16689 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016690
16691http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016692 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16693 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16694 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016696http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016697 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16698 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016699 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16700 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016702method : integer + string
16703 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16704 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16705 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16706 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16707 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16708 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16709 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016711 ACL derivatives :
16712 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016714 Example :
16715 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16716 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16717 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016719path : string
16720 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16721 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16722 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16723 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16724 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016725 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016726 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728 ACL derivatives :
16729 path : exact string match
16730 path_beg : prefix match
16731 path_dir : subdir match
16732 path_dom : domain match
16733 path_end : suffix match
16734 path_len : length match
16735 path_reg : regex match
16736 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016737
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016738query : string
16739 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16740 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16741 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16742 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016743 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016744 which stops before the question mark.
16745
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016746req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16747 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16748 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16749 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16750 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016752req.ver : string
16753req_ver : string (deprecated)
16754 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16755 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16756 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016758 ACL derivatives :
16759 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016761res.comp : boolean
16762 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16763 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16764 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766res.comp_algo : string
16767 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16768 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16769 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771res.cook([<name>]) : string
16772scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16773 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16774 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16775 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016777 ACL derivatives :
16778 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16781scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16782 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16783 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16784 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16787scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16788 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16789 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16790 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016792res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16793 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16794 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16795 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16796 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16797 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16798 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16799 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16800 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16801 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16804 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16805 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16806 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16807 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16808 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16811shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16812 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16813 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16814 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16815 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16816 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16817 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16818 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16819 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821 ACL derivatives :
16822 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16823 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16824 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16825 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16826 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16827 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16828 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16829 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16830
16831res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16832shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16833 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16834 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16835 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16836 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16837 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16840shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16841 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16842 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16843 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16844 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16845 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16846 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016847
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016848res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16849 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16850 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16851 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16852 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016854res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16855shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16856 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16857 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16858 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16859 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16860 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16861 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016863res.ver : string
16864resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16865 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16866 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016868 ACL derivatives :
16869 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016871set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16872 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16873 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016874 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016875 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016877 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16878 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016880status : integer
16881 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16882 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16883 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016884
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016885unique-id : string
16886 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16887 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16888 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16889 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16890 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16891 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016893url : string
16894 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16895 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16896 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16897 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16898 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16899 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16900 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016902 ACL derivatives :
16903 url : exact string match
16904 url_beg : prefix match
16905 url_dir : subdir match
16906 url_dom : domain match
16907 url_end : suffix match
16908 url_len : length match
16909 url_reg : regex match
16910 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016912url_ip : ip
16913 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16914 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16915 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16916 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16917 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16918 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16919 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016921url_port : integer
16922 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16923 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16924 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16925 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016926
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016927urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16928url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016929 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16930 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016931 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16932 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16933 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16934 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016935 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16936 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016937 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16938 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016940 ACL derivatives :
16941 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16942 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16943 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16944 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16945 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16946 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16947 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16948 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016949
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016951 Example :
16952 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16953 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16954 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16955 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016956
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016957urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016958 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16959 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16960 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016961
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016962url32 : integer
16963 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16964 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16965 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16966 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16967 is an unsigned integer.
16968
16969url32+src : binary
16970 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16971 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16972 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16973
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016974
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100169757.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16976---------------------------------------
16977
16978This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16979used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16980purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16981There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16982or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16983any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16984for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16985
16986internal.htx.data : integer
16987 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16988 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16989
16990internal.htx.free : integer
16991 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16992 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16993
16994internal.htx.free_data : integer
16995 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16996 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16997
16998internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16999 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17000 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17001 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17002
17003internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17004 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17005 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17006
17007internal.htx.size : integer
17008 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17009 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17010
17011internal.htx.used : integer
17012 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17013 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17014 direction.
17015
17016internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17017 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17018 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17019 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17020 of the special value :
17021 * head : The oldest inserted block
17022 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017023 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017024
17025internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17026 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17027 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17028 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17029 integer or one of the special value :
17030 * head : The oldest inserted block
17031 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017032 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017033
17034internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17035 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17036 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17037 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17038 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17039
17040 * head : The oldest inserted block
17041 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017042 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017043
17044internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17045 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17046 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17047 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17048 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17049
17050 * head : The oldest inserted block
17051 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017052 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017053
17054internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17055 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17056 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17057 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17058 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17059
17060 * head : The oldest inserted block
17061 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017062 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017063
17064internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17065 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17066 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17067 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17068 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17069
17070 * head : The oldest inserted block
17071 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017072 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017073
17074internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17075 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17076 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17077 it returns false.
17078
17079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170807.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017081---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017083Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17084every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017085order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017087ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17088---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017089FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017090HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017091HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17092HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017093HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17094HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17095HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17096HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17097LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017098METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017099METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017100METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17101METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17102METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17103METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017104METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017105METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017106RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017107REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017108TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017109WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17110---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017111
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171138. Logging
17114----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017115
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017116One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17117provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17118very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17119provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17120state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017121to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017122headers.
17123
17124In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17125about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17126send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17127
17128 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17129 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17130 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17131 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17132 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017133 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017134 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017135
17136The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17137allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17138as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17139while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17140real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17141delay.
17142
17143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171448.1. Log levels
17145---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017146
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017147TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017148source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017149HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17150in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17151track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17152syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17153about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017154
17155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171568.2. Log formats
17157----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017158
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017159HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017160and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17161slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17162options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017163
17164 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17165 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17166 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17167 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17168 extents.
17169
17170 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17171 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17172 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17173 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17174 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17175
17176 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17177 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17178 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17179 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17180 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17181
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017182 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17183 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17184 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17185 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17186
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017187 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17188
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017189Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17190specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17191field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17192servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17193always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17194identifier.
17195
17196Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17197 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17198 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17199 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17200 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17201
17202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172038.2.1. Default log format
17204-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017205
17206This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17207as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17208format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17209
17210 Example :
17211 listen www
17212 mode http
17213 log global
17214 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17215
17216 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17217 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17218 (www/HTTP)
17219
17220 Field Format Extract from the example above
17221 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17222 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17223 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17224 4 'to' to
17225 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17226 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17227
17228Detailed fields description :
17229 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17230 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17231 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17232 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17233 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17234 and processed the connection.
17235 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17236
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017237In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17238"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17239connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17240
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017241It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17242will eventually disappear.
17243
17244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172458.2.2. TCP log format
17246---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017247
17248The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17249is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17250information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17251counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17252emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17253environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17254the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17255sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017256specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17257not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17258fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17259marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017260
17261 Example :
17262 frontend fnt
17263 mode tcp
17264 option tcplog
17265 log global
17266 default_backend bck
17267
17268 backend bck
17269 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17270
17271 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17272 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17273 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17274
17275 Field Format Extract from the example above
17276 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17277 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17278 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17279 4 frontend_name fnt
17280 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17281 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17282 7 bytes_read* 212
17283 8 termination_state --
17284 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17285 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17286
17287Detailed fields description :
17288 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017289 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17290 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17291 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017292 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017293 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017294 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295
17296 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017297 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17298 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17299 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017300
17301 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17302 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17303 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017304 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17305 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17306 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17307 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308
17309 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17310 and processed the connection.
17311
17312 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17313 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17314 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17315 applications.
17316
17317 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17318 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17319 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17320 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17321 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17322
17323 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17324 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17325 See "Timers" below for more details.
17326
17327 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17328 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17329 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17330 "Timers" below for more details.
17331
17332 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017333 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017334 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17335 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17336 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17337 details.
17338
17339 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17340 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17341 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17342 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17343 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17344
17345 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17346 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17347 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17348 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17349 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17350 for more details.
17351
17352 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017353 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017354 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17355 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17356 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017357 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017358
17359 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17360 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17361 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17362 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17363 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17364 caused by a denial of service attack.
17365
17366 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17367 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17368 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17369 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17370 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17371 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17372 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17373 denial of service attack.
17374
17375 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17376 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17377 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17378 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17379 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17380 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17381 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17382 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17383 be processed than on other servers.
17384
17385 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17386 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17387 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17388 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17389 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17390 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17391 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17392 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17393 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17394 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17395 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17396 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17397 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17398
17399 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17400 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17401 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17402 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17403 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17404 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017405 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17407
17408 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17409 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17410 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17411 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17412 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17413 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017414 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017415 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17416 occurs.
17417
17418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174198.2.3. HTTP log format
17420----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017421
17422The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17423is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17424the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17425are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17426emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17427generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17428"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17429which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017430frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17431is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017432
17433Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17434slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17435with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17436
17437 Example :
17438 frontend http-in
17439 mode http
17440 option httplog
17441 log global
17442 default_backend bck
17443
17444 backend static
17445 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17446
17447 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17448 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17449 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017450 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017451
17452 Field Format Extract from the example above
17453 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17454 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017455 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017456 4 frontend_name http-in
17457 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017458 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017459 7 status_code 200
17460 8 bytes_read* 2750
17461 9 captured_request_cookie -
17462 10 captured_response_cookie -
17463 11 termination_state ----
17464 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17465 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17466 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17467 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17468 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017469
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017470Detailed fields description :
17471 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017472 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17473 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17474 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017475 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017476 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017477 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017478
17479 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017480 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17481 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17482 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017484 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17485 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017486
17487 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17488 and processed the connection.
17489
17490 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17491 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17492 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17493
17494 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17495 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17496 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17497 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17498 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17499 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17500
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017501 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17502 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17503 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017504 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017505 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17506 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017507 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17508 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017509
17510 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17511 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017512 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017513
17514 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17515 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017516 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17517 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017518
17519 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17520 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17521 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17522 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17523 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017524 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17525 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017526
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017527 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17528 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17529 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17530 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17531 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17532 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17533 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017534 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017535
17536 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17537 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17538 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17539
17540 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17541 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017542 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017543 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17544 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17545 overflowing.
17546
17547 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17548 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17549 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17550 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17551 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17552 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17553 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17554 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17555
17556 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17557 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17558 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17559 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17560 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17561 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17562 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17563 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17564
17565 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17566 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17567 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17568 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17569 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17570 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17571 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17572
17573 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017574 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017575 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17576 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17577 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017578 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017579 system.
17580
17581 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17582 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17583 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17584 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17585 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17586 caused by a denial of service attack.
17587
17588 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17589 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17590 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17591 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17592 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17593 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17594 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17595 denial of service attack.
17596
17597 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17598 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17599 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17600 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17601 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17602 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17603 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17604 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17605 processed than on other servers.
17606
17607 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17608 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17609 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17610 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17611 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17612 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17613 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17614 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17615 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17616 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17617 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17618 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17619 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17620
17621 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17622 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17623 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17624 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17625 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17626 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017627 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017628 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17629
17630 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17631 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17632 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17633 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17634 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17635 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017636 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017637 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17638 occurs.
17639
17640 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17641 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17642 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17643 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17644 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17645 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17646 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17647 cookies" below for more details.
17648
17649 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17650 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17651 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17652 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17653 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17654 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17655 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17656 and cookies" below for more details.
17657
17658 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17659 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17660 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17661 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17662 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17663 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17664 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17665 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17666
17667
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200176688.2.4. Custom log format
17669------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017670
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017671The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017672mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017673
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017674HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017675Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17676separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17677prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17678
17679Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17680variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017681("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017682
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017683If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017684as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017685less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17686the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17687
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017688Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017689In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017690in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017691
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017692Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17693'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17694https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17695such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17696
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017697Flags are :
17698 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017699 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017700 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17701 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017702
17703 Example:
17704
17705 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17706 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17707
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017708 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17709
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017710At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17711
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017712 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17713 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017714
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017715the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017716
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017717 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17718 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17719 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017720
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017721and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17722
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017723 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17724 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017725
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017726Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17727
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017728 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017729 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017730 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17731 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17732 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017733 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17734 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17735 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017736 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017737 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17738 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017739 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017740 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17741 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017742 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017743 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017744 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017745 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017746 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017747 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017748 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017749 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17750 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17751 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17752 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17753 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017754 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017755 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17756 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017757 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017758 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17759 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017760 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17761 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17762 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017763 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017764 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17765 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017766 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017767 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17768 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17769 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017770 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017771 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017772 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17773 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17774 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17775 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017776 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017777 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017778 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017779 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017780 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017781 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017782 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17783 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17784 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017785 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017786 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17787 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017788 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017789 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17790 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017791 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017792 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017793 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017794 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017795
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017796 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017797
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017798
177998.2.5. Error log format
17800-----------------------
17801
17802When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17803protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17804By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17805"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017806will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017807logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17808
17809The format looks like this :
17810
17811 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17812 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17813 Connection error during SSL handshake
17814
17815 Field Format Extract from the example above
17816 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17817 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17818 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17819 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17820 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17821
17822These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17823failures.
17824
17825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178268.3. Advanced logging options
17827-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017828
17829Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17830just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17831options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17832for more information about their usage.
17833
17834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178358.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17836------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017837
17838It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17839haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17840commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17841monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17842ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17843
17844 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17845 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17846 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17847 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17848
17849 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17850 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17851 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017852 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017853 such as other load-balancers.
17854
17855 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17856 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17857 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17858
17859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178608.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17861----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017862
17863The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17864what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17865or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017866"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017867just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17868log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17869after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17870is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17871with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17872with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17873
17874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178758.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17876------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017877
17878Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17879for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17880"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17881retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17882raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17883a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17884file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17885you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17886"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17887
17888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178898.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17890--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017891
17892Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17893multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17894them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17895"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17896logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17897error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17898and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17899too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17900useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17901alternative.
17902
17903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179048.4. Timing events
17905------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017906
17907Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17908reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17909the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17910frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017911mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17912addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17913
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017914Timings events in HTTP mode:
17915
17916 first request 2nd request
17917 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17918 t tr t tr ...
17919 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17920 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17921 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17922 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17923 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17924
17925Timings events in TCP mode:
17926
17927 TCP session
17928 |<----------------->|
17929 t t
17930 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17931 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17932 |<------ Tt ------->|
17933
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017934 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017935 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017936 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17937 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17938 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017939 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017940 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17941 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17942 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17943 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017944
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017945 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17946 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17947 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017948 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17949 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17950 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17951 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17952 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17953 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017954
17955 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17956 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17957 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17958 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17959 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17960 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17961 request typed by hand during a test.
17962
17963 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17964 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017965 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017966 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17967 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17968 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17969 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017970
17971 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17972 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17973 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17974 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17975 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17976
17977 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17978 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17979 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17980 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17981 connection never established.
17982
17983 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17984 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17985 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17986 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17987 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17988 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17989 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17990 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17991 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17992 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17993 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17994
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017995 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17996 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17997 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17998 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17999 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18000 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18001
18002 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18003
18004 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18005 "Ta" can never be negative.
18006
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018007 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18008 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018009 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18010 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018011 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018012
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018013 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018014
18015 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018016 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18017 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018018
18019These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18020protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18021that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018022due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18023"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18024that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025
18026Most common cases :
18027
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018028 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18029 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18030 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18031 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18032 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18033 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18034 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18035 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18036 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18037 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18038 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018039 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018040
18041 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18042 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18043 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18044 of ms on remote networks.
18045
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018046 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18047 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18048 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018049
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018050 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18051 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18052 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18053 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18054 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18055 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18056 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18057 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18058 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018059
18060Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18061
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018062 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018063 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018064 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018065
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018066 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018067 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18068 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18069
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018070 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018071 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18072 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18073 flags.
18074
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018075 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18076 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018077 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18078 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18079 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18080 the client connection was maintained open.
18081
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018082 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018083 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018084 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018085 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18086
18087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180888.5. Session state at disconnection
18089-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018090
18091TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18092"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
180932-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18094each of which has a special meaning :
18095
18096 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18097 session to terminate :
18098
18099 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18100
18101 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18102 server explicitly refused it.
18103
18104 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18105 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18106 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18107 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018108 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018109
18110 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18111 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018112
18113 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18114 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18115 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18116 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18117 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18118
18119 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18120 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18121 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18122 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18123 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18124
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018125 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18126 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18127
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018128 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18129 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18130 backup connections when going up.
18131
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018132 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18133
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018134 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18135 send or receive data.
18136
18137 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18138 send or receive data.
18139
18140 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18141 with nothing left in the buffers.
18142
18143 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18144
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018145 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018146 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18147
18148 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18149 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18150 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18151 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18152 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18153
18154 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18155 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18156
18157 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18158 server (HTTP only).
18159
18160 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18161
18162 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18163 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18164 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18165
18166 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18167 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18168 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18169
18170 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18171
18172 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18173 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18174
18175 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18176 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18177 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18178
18179 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18180 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018181 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18182 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018183
18184 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18185 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18186 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18187 another server.
18188
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018189 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018190 server.
18191
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018192 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18193 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18194 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18195 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18196
18197 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18198 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18199 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18200 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18201
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018202 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18203 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18204 "use-server" rule).
18205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018206 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18207
18208 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18209 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18210
18211 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18212
18213 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18214 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18215 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18216
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018217 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18218 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018219 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018220 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18221 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018223 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18224
18225 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18226 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18227
18228 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18229
18230 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18231
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018232The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18233was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018234helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18235starvation, attacks, etc...
18236
18237The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18238alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18239easier finding and understanding.
18240
18241 Flags Reason
18242
18243 -- Normal termination.
18244
18245 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18246 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18247 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18248 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18249
18250 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18251 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18252 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18253 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18254 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18255 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018256
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018257 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18258 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018259 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018260
18261 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18262 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18263 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18264
18265 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18266 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18267 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18268 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18269 the server takes too long to respond.
18270
18271 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18272 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18273 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18274 long a time to respond.
18275
18276 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18277 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18278 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18279 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018280 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18281 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018282
18283 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18284 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18285 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18286 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18287 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018288 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018289 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18290 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18291 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18292 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18293 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18294 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18295 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18296 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018297 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018298 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18299 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18300 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018301
18302 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18303 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018304 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18305 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18306 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18307 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018308
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018309 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18310 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018312 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018313 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18314 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018315 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018316 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18317 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18318
18319 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18320 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18321 503 or 504 here.
18322
18323 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18324 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18325 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18326 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18327 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18328
18329 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18330 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018331 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018332 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18333 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18334
18335 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18336 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18337 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18338 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18339 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18340 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18341 between haproxy and the server.
18342
18343 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18344 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18345 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18346 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18347 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18348 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18349 solution is to fix the application.
18350
18351 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18352 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18353 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18354 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18355 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18356 external attacks.
18357
18358 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18359 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018360 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018361 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18362 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18363
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018364 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18365 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18366 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018367 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018368 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018369
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018370 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18371 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18372 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18373 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018374 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18375 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18376 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18377 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18378 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018379
18380 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18381 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18382 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18383 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18384
18385 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18386 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18387 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18388 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18389
18390 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18391 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18392 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18393 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18394
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018395The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18396persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18397important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18398re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18399
18400 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18401
18402 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18403 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18404 set on a GET request.
18405
18406 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18407 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018408 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018409 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18410
18411 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18412 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18413 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18414
18415 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18416 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18417 already got a cookie.
18418
18419 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18420 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18421 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18422 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18423 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18424
18425 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18426 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18427 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18428
18429 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18430 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18431 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18432
18433 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18434 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18435
18436 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18437 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18438 then advertised in the response.
18439
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184418.6. Non-printable characters
18442-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018443
18444In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18445consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18446converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18447prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18448being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18449escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18450is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18451'}' when logging headers.
18452
18453Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18454issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18455containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18456
18457Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18458the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18459performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18460
18461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184628.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18463---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018464
18465Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18466achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018467section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018468cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18469the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18470the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018471locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018472not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18473user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18474a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18475wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18476
18477 Examples :
18478 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18479 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18480
18481 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18482 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18483
18484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184858.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18486---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018487
18488Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18489proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18490the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18491server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18492
18493Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18494response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018495section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018496
18497It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018498time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18499appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018500are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18501and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18502follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18503request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18504in the logs.
18505
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018506As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18507frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18508an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18509
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018510 Example :
18511 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18512 listen proxy-out
18513 mode http
18514 option httplog
18515 option logasap
18516 log global
18517 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18518
18519 # log the name of the virtual server
18520 capture request header Host len 20
18521
18522 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18523 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18524
18525 # log the beginning of the referrer
18526 capture request header Referer len 20
18527
18528 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18529 capture response header Server len 20
18530
18531 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18532 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18533
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018534 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018535 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18536
18537 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18538 capture response header Via len 20
18539
18540 # log the URL location during a redirection
18541 capture response header Location len 20
18542
18543 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18544 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18545 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18546 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18547 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18548
18549 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18550 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18551 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18552 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018553 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018554
18555 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18556 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18557 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18558 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18559 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018560 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018561
18562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185638.9. Examples of logs
18564---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018565
18566These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18567them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18568reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18569
18570 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18571 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18572 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18573
18574 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18575 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18576
18577 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18578 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18579 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18580
18581 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18582 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18583
18584 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18585 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18586 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18587
18588 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018589 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018590 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18591 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18592
18593 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18594 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18595 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18596
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018597 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18598 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18599 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18600 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18601 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18602 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018603
18604 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018605 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018606
18607 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18608 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18609 Nothing was sent to any server.
18610
18611 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18612 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18613
18614 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18615 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018616 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018617 send a 408 return code to the client.
18618
18619 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18620 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18621
18622 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18623 5 seconds ("c----").
18624
18625 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18626 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018627 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018628
18629 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018630 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018631 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18632 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18633 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18634 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18635 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018636
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018637
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200186389. Supported filters
18639--------------------
18640
18641Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18642accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18643unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18644
18645See also : "filter"
18646
186479.1. Trace
18648----------
18649
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018650filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018651
18652 Arguments:
18653 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18654 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18655
18656 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18657 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18658 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18659 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18660
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018661 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018662 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18663 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18664 amount of the parsed data.
18665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018666 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018667
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018668This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18669callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18670information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18671filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18672
18673Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18674tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18675a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18676
18677
186789.2. HTTP compression
18679---------------------
18680
18681filter compression
18682
18683The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18684keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018685when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18686fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18687done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18688explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18689filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18690listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18691order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018692
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018693See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18694 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018695
18696
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200186979.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18698--------------------------------------------
18699
18700filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18701
18702 Arguments :
18703
18704 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18705 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18706 parsed.
18707
18708 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18709 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18710 part must be placed in its own scope.
18711
18712The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18713external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018714streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018715exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18716also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18717
18718SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18719the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18720
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018721For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018722"doc/SPOE.txt".
18723
18724Important note:
18725 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18726 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18727
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100187289.4. Cache
18729----------
18730
18731filter cache <name>
18732
18733 Arguments :
18734
18735 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18736
18737The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18738"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018739cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018740other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18741case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18742is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18743filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018744listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18745order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018746
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018747See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18748 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18749
18750
187519.5. Fcgi-app
18752-------------
18753
18754filter fcg-app <name>
18755
18756 Arguments :
18757
18758 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18759
18760The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18761request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18762reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18763used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18764implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18765used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18766fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18767used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18768order.
18769
18770See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18771 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18772
18773
1877410. FastCGI applications
18775-------------------------
18776
18777HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18778feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18779the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18780FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18781servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18782FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18783backend.
18784
18785HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18786application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18787connection.
18788
1878910.1. Setup
18790-----------
18791
1879210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18793--------------------------
18794
18795fcgi-app <name>
18796 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18797 document root must be defined.
18798
18799acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18800 Declare or complete an access list.
18801
18802 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18803 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18804 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18805 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18806 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18807
18808docroot <path>
18809 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18810 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18811 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18812
18813index <script-name>
18814 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18815 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18816 is an optional setting.
18817
18818 Example :
18819 index index.php
18820
18821log-stderr global
18822log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18823 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18824 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18825
18826 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18827 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18828
18829pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18830 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18831 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18832 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18833
18834 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18835 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18836 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18837 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18838
18839 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18840 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18841
18842path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018843 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018844 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
18845 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
18846 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
18847 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
18848 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18849 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
18850 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018851
18852 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018853 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018854 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
18855 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
18856 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
18857 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018858
18859 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018860 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
18861 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018862
18863option get-values
18864no option get-values
18865 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18866
18867 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18868 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18869
18870 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18871 application will accept.
18872
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018873 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18874 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018875
18876 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18877 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18878 option is disabled.
18879
18880 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18881 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18882 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18883 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18884 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18885 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18886
18887option keep-conn
18888no option keep-conn
18889 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18890 sending a response.
18891
18892 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18893 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18894
18895option max-reqs <reqs>
18896 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18897 accept.
18898
18899 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18900 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18901 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18902 to 1.
18903
18904option mpxs-conns
18905no option mpxs-conns
18906 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18907
18908 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18909 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18910
18911set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18912 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18913 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18914 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18915 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18916
18917 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18918 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18919 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18920
18921 Example :
18922 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18923 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18924
18925 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18926
18927
1892810.1.2. Proxy section
18929---------------------
18930
18931use-fcgi-app <name>
18932 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18933
18934 Arguments :
18935 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18936
18937 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18938 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18939 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18940 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18941 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18942
18943 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18944 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18945 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18946 application are evaluated.
18947
18948
1894910.1.3. Example
18950---------------
18951
18952 frontend front-http
18953 mode http
18954 bind *:80
18955 bind *:
18956
18957 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18958 default_backend back-static
18959
18960 backend back-static
18961 mode http
18962 server www A.B.C.D:80
18963
18964 backend back-dynamic
18965 mode http
18966 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18967 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18968
18969 fcgi-app php-fpm
18970 log-stderr global
18971 option keep-conn
18972
18973 docroot /var/www/my-app
18974 index index.php
18975 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18976
18977
1897810.2. Default parameters
18979------------------------
18980
18981A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18982the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018983script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018984applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18985
18986 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18987 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18988 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18989 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18990 | | |
18991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18992 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18993 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18994 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18995 | | application. |
18996 | | |
18997 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18998 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18999 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19000 | | |
19001 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19002 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19003 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19004 | | the application's configuration. |
19005 | | |
19006 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19007 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19008 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19009 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19010 | | |
19011 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19012 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19013 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19014 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19015 | | be defined. |
19016 | | |
19017 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19018 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19019 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19020 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19021 | | is not set too. |
19022 | | |
19023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19024 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19025 | | set. |
19026 | | |
19027 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19028 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19029 | | the request. |
19030 | | |
19031 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19032 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19033 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19034 | | |
19035 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19036 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19037 | | script to process the request. |
19038 | | |
19039 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19040 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19041 | | |
19042 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19043 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19044 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19045 | | |
19046 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19047 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19048 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19049 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19050 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19051 | | |
19052 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19053 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19054 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19055 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19056 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19057 | | side. |
19058 | | |
19059 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19060 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19061 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19062 | | connected to. |
19063 | | |
19064 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19065 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19066 | | |
19067 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19068 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19069 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19070 | | |
19071 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19072
19073
1907410.3. Limitations
19075------------------
19076
19077The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19078way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19079during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19080establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19081application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19082or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19083message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19084these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19085and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19086
19087Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19088request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19089requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19090
19091About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19092into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19093fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19094"http-request" ones.
19095
19096Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19097FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19098processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19099must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19100here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019102/*
19103 * Local variables:
19104 * fill-column: 79
19105 * End:
19106 */